Jaguar Automobile JJM 18 02 30 701 User Manual

OWNER’S HANDBOOK  
Publication Part No. JJM 18 02 30 701  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Handbook Contents  
Quick Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . 281  
Technical Specifications . . . . . . . . . 282  
Type Approvals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286  
Filling Station Information . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Introduction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Keys and Remote Controls . . . . . . . . . 34  
Locks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Engine Immobiliser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
Fuel and Refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
Driving Hints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57  
Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
Wipers and Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65  
Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
Windows and Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86  
Occupant Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91  
Child Safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103  
Facia and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109  
Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111  
Information Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118  
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
Convenience Features . . . . . . . . . . . 139  
Convertible Top. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147  
Load Carrying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156  
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
Stability Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165  
Parking Aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169  
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) . . . . . 172  
Automatic Speed Limiter (ASL) . . . . . 180  
Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182  
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199  
Telephone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
Emergency Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
Status After a Collision . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Vehicle Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
Vehicle Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232  
Vehicle Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242  
Fuses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247  
Wheels and Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
A comprehensive index is located at the  
back of this handbook.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Quick Start  
Quick Start  
KEYLESS ENTRY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
REMOTE HANDSET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
CENTRAL LOCKING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT . . . . . . . . 8  
ENGINE START/STOP . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
SEAT ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
STEERING COLUMN - LOCK AND  
ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
INTERIOR MIRROR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10  
WINDOWS/DOOR MIRRORS . . . . . . . 11  
SEAT POSITION MEMORY . . . . . . . . 11  
SEAT BELTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
CENTRE CONSOLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
OVERHEAD CONSOLE . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
CLIMATE CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
FACIA AND CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . 15  
EXTERIOR LAMPS/TRIP COMPUTER 17  
WIPERS AND WASHERS . . . . . . . . . . 17  
WARNING INDICATORS . . . . . . . . . . 17  
PARKBRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
PARKING ASSIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
CRUISE (SPEED) CONTROL . . . . . . . 21  
ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL (ACC) 21  
TOUCH-SCREEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
SOUND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
RADIO OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
CD OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
NAVIGATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
TELEPHONE -  
BLUETOOTH SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Filling Station Information  
FUEL TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
HOOD RELEASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
UNDERHOOD TOP-UP . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
ULTRA HIGH PERFORMANCE  
TYRES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
TIRE PRESSURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING  
SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Quick Start  
KEYLESS ENTRY  
REMOTE HANDSET  
Entering the vehicle  
The keyless entry system allows access  
to the vehicle without the need for  
pressing the unlock button on the remote  
handset.  
When a door handle, or the luggage  
compartment release button are  
operated, the vehicle will search for a  
recognised remote handset signal before  
unlocking. The handset must be within  
one metre of the entry point.  
JAG0423G  
The buttons on the remote handset can  
be used to lock/unlock the vehicle when  
approaching or leaving the vehicle.  
Press once to lock the vehicle and  
arm the alarm.  
Leaving the vehicle  
Press twice within three seconds to  
double lock the vehicle.  
The vehicle will not automatically lock, or  
arm the alarm. To leave the vehicle in a  
secure condition either:  
Press once to disarm the alarm,  
unlock the driver’s door, and unlock  
the luggage compartment.  
Press again to unlock the passenger  
door.  
JAG0424G  
press the button on the door handle  
once (arrowed in the illustration)  
or press the lock button on the remote  
handset.  
Press once to switch the headlamps  
on for 25 seconds. Press again to  
switch off.  
Press to deactivate the alarm, and  
unlock the luggage compartment.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT  
Caution: If the luggage compartment is  
opened when the driver and passenger  
doors are locked, ensure that the  
Jaguar Smart Key remains outside the  
vehicle when it is closed again. If the  
Jaguar Smart key is inadvertently left  
inside the vehicle (luggage  
Press three times in three seconds, or  
press and hold for longer than three  
seconds to activate/cancel the panic  
alarm.  
Unlocking mode alternatives  
compartment) an audible alarm will  
sound and the luggage compartment  
lid will initially re-open. If the lid is  
subsequently closed without removing  
the Jaguar Smart Key from the luggage  
compartment, you will be locked out.  
You should contact your Jaguar  
Dealer.  
Single stage unlocking will unlock the  
vehicle with a single press. Two stage  
unlocking will unlock the driver’s door  
with a single press, and all other doors  
with a second press.  
To change between modes, press and  
hold the unlock button for four seconds.  
The direction indicators will flash twice to  
confirm the change.  
The luggage compartment is electrically  
locked in conjunction with the driver’s  
door.  
CENTRAL LOCKING  
To open the luggage compartment with  
the vehicle locked:  
Interior door locks  
Press either of the interior door release  
levers to lock both doors and the luggage  
compartment.  
press the luggage compartment  
button on the remote handset.  
To open the luggage compartment with  
the vehicle unlocked:  
Pull the release lever to unlock the door.  
Drive away door locking  
press the button on the facia.  
This feature can be enabled or disabled  
via the Vehicle - Security settings on the  
touch-screen.  
If enabled, the luggage compartment and  
doors will automatically lock when the  
vehicle’s forward speed exceeds 7 km/h  
(5 mph).  
JAG0425G  
Or:  
press the release button on the  
luggage compartment lid.  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
ENGINE START/STOP  
JAG0426G  
Emergency key blade access  
JAG0428G  
The engine START/STOP button is only  
operational when a recognised remote  
handset is detected within the vehicle.  
A single press of the engine start/stop  
button will switch on the ignition  
system.  
JAG0427G  
Another press of the switch will switch  
off the ignition system.  
In the event of a discharged vehicle  
battery, or other problem opening the  
luggage compartment, it can be opened  
by using the key blade in the luggage  
compartment lock.  
With the gear selector in P (Park) and  
the brake pedal depressed, press the  
engine START/STOP button to start  
the engine.  
Care points  
Press the button to stop the engine  
and switch off the ignition.  
The registration plate has to be  
removed to access the luggage  
compartment lock.  
The vehicle’s alarm will sound if the  
luggage compartment is unlocked  
with the key blade, whilst the vehicle  
is locked.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Steering column adjustment  
SEAT ADJUSTMENT  
3
1
2
5
4
JAG0430G  
JAG0429 L  
Turn the control on the left-hand side of  
the steering column to COLUMN and  
move to adjust the height and reach.  
1. Cushion extension switch.  
2. Lower backrest and lumbar support  
switch.  
Automatic steering column movement  
3. Recline adjustment switch.  
If the control is set to AUTO, the position  
of the steering column will automatically  
adjust to provide greater clearance for  
exit and entry when the driver’s door is  
opened for exiting the vehicle.  
4. Side bolster adjustment switch.  
Rotate to adjust the side bolster  
cushions.  
5. Fore/aft, cushion height, and front tilt  
control switch.  
The steering column will return to the  
driving position when the driver’s door is  
closed and the engine start button is  
pressed.  
Note: Seat heating adjustment is via the  
main touch-screen, see page 61.  
STEERING COLUMN - LOCK  
AND ADJUSTMENT  
Note: To prevent automatic movement of  
the steering column, turn the control to  
the COLUMN position.  
Steering column lock  
The steering column has an electronic  
lock that is automatically disengaged  
whenever a recognised remote handset is  
inside the vehicle.  
INTERIOR MIRROR  
With the ignition on, the rear view mirror  
will automatically darken in proportion to  
the amount of glare detected from a  
following vehicle’s headlamps. This  
feature is automatically switched off when  
reverse gear is selected.  
Vehicle recovery  
Caution: If the vehicle requires  
recovery assistance, the remote  
handset must remain in the vehicle to  
prevent the steering column lock  
engaging.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
WINDOWS/DOOR MIRRORS  
SEAT POSITION MEMORY  
Front windows  
The windows are fitted with a facility that  
allows them to be fully opened or closed  
with a single operation of the switch.  
To open the window, press the  
respective switch. Press the switch  
again to stop the window from fully  
opening.  
JAG0432L  
To close the window, pull the switch  
up. Pull the switch again to prevent to  
window from closing fully.  
Driver’s seat  
Once you have adjusted the driver’s seat,  
steering column, and exterior mirrors, the  
vehicle can memorise these settings for  
future use.  
Door mirror adjustment  
1
1. Push the memory button M, the red  
LED will illuminate for five seconds.  
2. Whilst the LED is illuminated, press  
button 1, 2, or 3, to memorise the  
current settings.  
The LED will extinguish, and a chime will  
sound to confirm that the settings have  
been memorised. If the ignition is on, the  
message centre will display a  
JAG0431 L  
confirmation message.  
Press the L (left) or R (right) button to  
select the required mirror for adjustment.  
Use the four-way switch 1 to adjust the  
position of the selected mirror.  
Passenger seat  
The procedure to memorise a passenger  
seat position is the same as that for the  
driver’s seat with two exceptions. There  
will be no chime or message to confirm  
the settings.  
Mirror dip when reversing  
The passenger door mirror can be  
programmed to dip automatically when R  
(reverse) is selected. This will provide a  
better view along the side of the vehicle to  
aid parking. The dip position of the mirror  
can be adjusted via the four-way switch.  
This feature can be enabled/disabled via  
the Vehicle - Parking settings on the  
Touch-screen.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Recalling a seat position  
CENTRE CONSOLE  
To recall a memorised seat position,  
simply press and hold button 1, 2, or 3.  
The button should be held until the seat  
has stopped moving.  
Note: A seat position will only be  
memorised during the five second period  
whilst the LED is illuminated.  
Any existing settings will be over-written  
when programming a memory position.  
JAG0433L  
Operate the release button, and slide the  
armrest rearwards to access the cup  
holders.  
SEAT BELTS  
!
WARNING:  
The use of front and rear seat belts is  
mandatory in most countries.  
Using seat belts saves lives.  
A warning indicator on the instrument  
panel will illuminate to warn you that the  
driver’s and/or front passenger’s seat belt  
is unbuckled. This may also be  
JAG0434L  
To open the cubby box, operate the  
release button, and lift the armrest. The  
armrest will slide back under it’s own  
weight to provide better access to the  
cubby box.  
accompanied by a warning chime.  
The cubby box has space to store six  
standard CD cases.  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Garage door opener  
For information on the Garage door  
opener buttons 2, see page 143.  
OVERHEAD CONSOLE  
Caution: Do not open or close the  
convertible top whilst the vehicle is in  
motion. Doing so may damage the  
convertible top and/or it’s operating  
mechanism.  
CLIMATE CONTROL  
The following are the primary functions of  
the climate control system. The climate  
control system can also be operated via  
the touch-screen, which gives access to  
other features, such as heated  
Do not press the engine stop/start  
button whilst the convertible top is  
opening or closing. Doing so will cause  
the system to loose it’s position  
memory.  
seats/steering wheel.  
1
2
JAG0505N  
JAG0562N  
Auto (automatic) mode  
Convertible top  
Press AUTO to turn on and select  
automatic operation of the climate control  
system. The system will automatically  
adjust the heat output, blower speed, air  
intake, and airflow distribution, to  
maintain the selected temperature, and  
reduce misting without the need for  
constant manual adjustments.  
When operating the convertible top, the  
switch must be pressed, and held, until  
the second chime is heard. The second  
chime confirms that the convertible top  
has reached the end of it’s operation.  
To open press and hold the rear of  
switch 1. The windows will fully open.  
To close press and hold the front of  
switch 1.  
The front and rear screen heating, and  
timed air recirculation, may be selected in  
AUTO mode. Selecting any other  
Rear windows  
The rear windows can be operated when  
the convertible top is closed.  
function will cancel AUTO operation.  
Air conditioning  
Air conditioning is an integral part of the  
climate control system. The air provided  
is cooled and dehumidified, which helps  
to prevent misting of the windows.  
To open press and release the rear of  
switch 1. The windows will open fully.  
To close press and hold the front of  
switch 1. Release the switch to stop  
raising the windows.  
Air conditioning is automatically switched  
on and controlled, whenever the system is  
operating in AUTO or DEF modes.  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
External water deposits  
Windshield defrost/demist  
The air conditioning system removes  
moisture from the air and deposits excess  
water beneath the vehicle. Puddles may  
form, but this is normal, and no cause for  
concern.  
Press the DEF button to remove frost or  
heavy misting from the windshield. To  
de-select defrost mode, press the DEF or  
AUTO buttons.  
Recommended mode  
Select AUTO as the normal operating  
mode. This will help prevent window  
misting and odours from the climate  
control system.  
Heated screen and door mirrors  
Air recirculation  
The rear screen heater can be switched  
on and off in any mode, even when the  
climate control system is off. It will only  
operate when the engine is running.  
Press the recirculation button to select. A  
symbol will appear on the Touch-screen  
and an LED in the button will illuminate.  
The door mirror heaters are controlled by  
the rear screen heater button.  
To de-select air recirculation, press the  
recirculation button again, or press the  
AUTO button.  
System off  
Blower speed  
Climate  
Set the blower speed as required by  
adjusting the rotary control knob. Any  
adjustment of the knob will cancel AUTO  
mode.  
Select the ON/OFF button located under  
the Climate tab on the touch-screen.  
Temperature selection  
Press the red buttons to increase the  
temperature, and the blue buttons to  
decrease the temperature.  
The passenger and driver temperatures  
will automatically synchronise if HI or LO  
is selected via the driver’s side control.  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
FACIA AND CONTROLS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14  
Auto  
km  
l/100km  
Inst Fuel  
22  
15  
16  
17  
21  
20  
23 24  
29  
28  
27  
26  
19  
18  
25  
JAG0511N  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
1. Steering wheel audio switches (64).  
16. Gear selector (157).  
2. External light switches (71).  
17. Automatic speed limiter switch (180).  
18. Parkbrake switch (164).  
3. Jaguar sequential gear change down  
paddle (159).  
19. Dynamic stability control mode switch  
4. Speedometer (111).  
(166).  
5. Driver’s horn and air bag (63).  
6. Message centre (118).  
7. Tachometer (111).  
20. Engine Start and Stop switch (50).  
21. Ashtray and cigar lighter (140).  
22. Steering column adjustment switch  
(62).  
8. Jaguar sequential gear change up  
paddle (159).  
23. Front fog lamp switch (75).  
24. Dimmer switch (140).  
9. Wiper and washer switch (65).  
10. Cruise control or adaptive cruise  
25. Rear fog lamp switch (75).  
control switches (169).  
26. Luggage compartment release switch  
11. Audio panel (184).  
(43).  
12. Hazard warning switch (76).  
13. Touch-screen display (121).  
14. Climate control panel (134).  
27. Forward alert switch (177).  
28. Fuel filler flap release switch (52).  
29. Hood release lever (234).  
15. Glove box compartment release  
Page numbers (shown in brackets) refer  
to pages in this handbook that have  
further relevant information.  
button (142).  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
EXTERIOR LAMPS/TRIP  
COMPUTER  
WIPERS AND WASHERS  
C
B
A
JAG0438G  
Move the stalk up or down to activate the  
direction indicators.  
JAG0439G  
A. Intermittent wipe.  
Press the button on the end of the stalk to  
cycle through the trip computer displays.  
B. Slow speed operation.  
C. High speed operation.  
Rotate the collar on the stalk to select:  
Press the button on the end of the stalk  
for wash/wipe. Rotate the collar to adjust  
the time delay for intermittent wipe, or to  
select AUTO for automatic operation of  
the wipers.  
sidelamps  
headlamps  
autolamps  
headlamp exit delay.  
In AUTO mode, a sensor monitors the  
exterior light levels. The sensor will  
automatically switch the sidelamps and  
dipped headlamps on and off.  
Enabling automatic operation  
The wiper stalk must be in position A and  
AUTO selected on the collar to enable  
automatic operation of the wipers.  
WARNING INDICATORS  
Sidelamps on. (Green).  
Headlamp main beam on. (Blue).  
Front fog lamps on. (Green).  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Rear fog lamp on. (Amber).  
Anti-Lock braking system fault (Amber)  
(Canada and Mexico only).  
Automatic Speed Limiter (ASL) active.  
(Green).  
Engine malfunction. (Amber).  
Direction indicator. (Green).  
Seat belt reminder. (Red).  
Forward alert active. (Amber).  
Dynamic Stability Control (DSC) off  
(normally aspirated engines only).  
TracDSC ON.  
DSC system fault (Amber).  
Adaptive Cruise Control active. (Amber).  
Air bag system fault. (Amber).  
Parkbrake on/Low brake fluid (Red)  
(USA only)  
Adaptive front lighting system fault.  
(Amber).  
Anti-Lock braking system fault (Amber)  
(USA only)  
Low tire pressure warning. (Yellow).  
Parkbrake on/Low brake fluid (Red)  
(Canada and Mexico only).  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Automatic exterior lamps  
TRANSMISSION  
If AUTO (autolamps) has been selected,  
and the windshield wipers are operated  
continuously for more than twenty  
seconds, then the exterior lamps will be  
switched on automatically.  
Gearshift interlock  
PARKBRAKE  
JAG0441G  
The ignition must be on, and the  
footbrake applied, before the gear  
selector can be moved from P (Park) to R  
(Reverse). The selector can be moved into  
P with the ignition off.  
JAG0440L  
Parkbrake will automatically release  
when the gear selector is moved from  
P (Park) with the footbrake applied.  
Sports mode  
When the gear selector is moved from D  
(Drive) to S (Sport) automatic changing of  
the gears is maintained. However, the  
gear shift points are modified to make full  
use of the engine’s power.  
Parkbrake can be manually released  
when the engine is running and the  
footbrake is applied. Press the  
parkbrake switch down to release,  
and pull it up to apply.  
Note: With the selector lever in S, and DS  
displayed in the message centre, the  
transmission will enter 6th gear less often  
at higher cruising speeds.  
If manually applied whilst in D or R,  
the Parkbrake will automatically  
release when the accelerator is  
applied.  
Fuel consumption will be adversely  
affected.  
Manual operation  
Manual changing of the gears via the  
steering wheel paddles is possible when  
the gear selector is in either D (Drive) or S  
(Sport).  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Operation of the paddles whilst in D will  
PARKING ASSIST  
temporarily select manual gear selection  
mode. This will be automatically  
cancelled after a short period of driving at  
a steady speed, or can be cancelled by  
holding the (+) paddle for approximately  
one second.  
Home  
Audi
Parking Aid Alert  
Clim
Phon
Operation of the paddles in S will  
permanently select manual gear  
selection. Once selected, it will only be  
cancelled if the gear selector is moved  
into D.  
Navi
Vehic
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
JAG0265NAS  
When R (Reverse) is selected, the  
Touch-screen displays a representation  
of the vehicle, and indicates any  
obstruction which is detected to the front  
or rear of the vehicle.  
If an obstruction is detected, a coloured  
bar will be displayed showing it’s  
approximate distance from the vehicle.  
This will be accompanied by an audible  
alert that increases frequency as the  
object is approached.  
The volume of the alert can be changed  
via the Vehicle - Parking settings on the  
Touch-screen.  
JAG0442G  
To shift down, briefly pull the  
(-) paddle.  
Parking assist is automatically cancelled  
when D (Drive) is selected, and the vehicle  
speed exceeds 15 km/h (9 mph).  
To shift up, briefly pull the (+) paddle.  
Parking assist care points  
Sensors may activate when water, snow,  
or ice, are detected on the surface of the  
sensors. This is normal for such sensors,  
and regular cleaning will maintain  
performance.  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Parking assist may sound if it detects a  
frequency range close to that of the  
sensors (e.g. motorcycles, or air brakes).  
ADAPTIVE CRUISE CONTROL  
(ACC)  
CRUISE (SPEED) CONTROL  
!
WARNING:  
Adaptive cruise control is not a  
collision avoidance system  
1
1
2
3
2
JAG0035G  
Speed control is the standard cruise  
control system which enables the vehicle  
to maintain a set road speed until either  
cruise control is cancelled, or the brake  
pedal is applied.  
4
3
JAG0274G  
Adaptive cruise control is designed to aid  
the driver maintain a gap to the vehicle  
ahead, or to maintain a SET road speed if  
there is no slower vehicle ahead.  
The system is controlled via switches on  
the steering wheel:  
The system is controlled via switches on  
the steering wheel:  
1. (+) or (-) to set the road speed to be  
maintained, or increase/decrease the  
speed in 2 km/h (1 mph) steps when  
cruise control is operating.  
1. (+) or (-)to set the road speed to be  
maintained, or increase/decrease the  
speed in 2 km/h (1 mph) steps when  
cruise control is operating.  
2. CANCEL - cancels cruise control, but  
retains the set speed in the memory.  
2. GAP - increase/decrease the time gap  
3. RESUME - to resume a set speed  
to the vehicle ahead.  
retained in the memory.  
3. CANCEL - cancels cruise control, but  
Note: Cruise control will automatically  
disengage when the brake pedal is  
applied, or when the vehicle speed falls  
below 30 km/h (18 mph).  
retains the set speed in the memory.  
4. RESUME - to resume a set speed  
retained in the memory.  
The gap to the vehicle ahead can be  
changed to one of four pre-defined  
intervals. The current setting will be  
displayed in the message centre.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
If a slower vehicle is  
encountered or enters the  
same lane as you, the road  
Press to put the Touch-screen into  
screen saver mode, press again to  
turn off the screen.  
speed will be adjusted to maintain the  
currently selected time gap. The warning  
light will illuminate to indicate that the  
vehicle is in follow mode.  
3. Home screen button. Press at any  
time to return to the Home screen.  
Most screens feature a return icon  
in the bottom right-hand corner.  
Touch this icon to return to the  
previous screen.  
Note: The system will not detect:  
Stationary, or slow moving vehicles  
below 10 km/h (6 mph).  
SOUND SETTINGS  
Pedestrians or objects in the roadway.  
Oncoming vehicles in the same lane.  
General operation  
TOUCH-SCREEN  
The Touch-screen allows control of the  
audio, climate, phone, and navigation  
systems. The screen only requires a light  
touch to operate functions. Excessive  
pressure on the screen can result in  
damage to the screen.  
JAG0445G  
Press the control knob to switch on/off,  
and rotate to adjust volume.  
1
Press the SOURCE button repeatedly to  
scroll through FM1, FM2, AM, and CD  
options.  
Home  
Audio  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
Steering wheel controls  
71.5  
F
70.0  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
1
2
2
3
JAG0444NAS  
1. Touch-screen. When initially  
activated, the Touch-screen will  
display the Home screen.  
4
3
JAG0034G  
2. Touch-screen On/Off. Press to turn  
the screen on.  
1. Rotate up or down to increase or  
decrease volume.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
2. Rotate up or down to scroll through  
The audio system has additional features  
which include: FM text, Traffic  
Announcements (TA), Programme Type  
(PTY), Regionalisation (REG), and  
Extended Other Networks (EON).  
preset radio stations or CD tracks.  
Holding the wheel in the up or down  
position for two seconds will seek  
forward or backwards to the next  
available signal.  
CD OPERATION  
3. Press repeatedly to scroll through  
FM1, FM2, AM, and CD options.  
DPLII  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
Tr 15  
:25  
4. Press to mute the audio unit. This  
4
3
/
Settings  
Folders  
button is also used in phone mode.  
RADIO OPERATION  
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
Caution: Ensure that the audio system  
is turned OFF so that the aerial is  
retracted before using an automatic  
car wash. Allow time for the aerial to  
retract.  
Mix  
Repeat  
2
5
6
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0447NAS  
From the Audio control screen, touch the  
CD icon to access the CD player control  
screen. The CD player has an integral  
6-disc multi changer. The example  
illustrated shows the multi changer  
loaded with four CD’s, with one disc  
playing.  
From the Audio control screen, touch the  
AM/FM tab to select radio. Subsequent  
touches of this icon will scroll through the  
available wavebands.  
Storing stations  
Touch Autostore to automatically store  
the nine strongest signals.  
Loading CDs  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
AM  
770  
WABC  
--  
1
/
Settings  
Autostore  
WFAN  
Insert a CD into the slot label side up, a  
CD loading message is displayed. Press  
and hold the LOAD button, and follow the  
on-screen instructions. Continue to load  
CDs until the player is full, or you have  
inserted the desired number.  
WCBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WABC  
TV  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
WPLJ  
2
WHUD  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0446NAS  
To manually store a station, search for the  
station using the seek icons 1. Once the  
station has been found, touch and hold  
one of the station icons 2 to store the  
station. An alert tone sounds to indicate  
that the station has been stored.  
To eject the selected CD, press the eject  
button. Press and hold to eject each CD in  
turn.  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
Playing a CD  
NAVIGATION  
1. To play a CD touch the icon for the  
The Navigation system features include:  
Compass, Points of Interest, Memory  
Points, Split screen, Previous destination,  
and Route preferences. For details of  
these features refer to the Navigation  
Handbook.  
required CD number.  
2.  
To pause play press the pause icon, a  
further press will continue playback.  
Setting a destination  
3.  
Menu  
Destination  
Entry  
Touch and release the skip forward  
icon to advance to the beginning of  
the next track. Touch and hold to  
advance through the current track,  
and subsequent tracks, until the icon  
is released.  
Stored  
Locations  
Route  
Options  
M
4
0
Navigation  
Setup  
Auto Voice  
GuidanceOff
12 : 26 pm  
4.  
JAG0453NAS  
Touch and release the skip back icon  
to return to the previous track. Touch  
and hold to move back through the  
current track, and subsequent tracks,  
until the icon is released.  
Zip code  
Input Zip code  
5
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
9
0
Q
W
E
R
T
Y
U
I
O
P
A
S
D
F
G
H
J
K
L
Z
X
C
V
B
N
M
Delete  
)
5. Touch and release Mix to randomly  
play tracks from the selected CD.  
Touch and hold for two seconds to  
play tracks randomly from all loaded  
CDs.  
,
(
OK  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0454NAS  
To set a destination and start using the  
system:  
6. Touch and release Repeat to play the  
selected track again. Touch and hold  
for two seconds to play the entire disc  
again.  
1. Select Navigation from the home  
screen, and when prompted touch  
Agree to access the initial map  
screen.  
2. Touch Menu to access the navigation  
menu, then touch Destination Entry.  
If the map is displayed, select Menu  
to access the Destination Entry.  
3. Touch Address or Postcode.  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
4. Enter the Town, Address, and  
Cancelling guidance  
House Number, using the on-screen  
keypad. Select the Display Map  
button and then select Destination.  
For post code entry, enter the post  
code.  
To cancel guidance go to Menu, Route  
Options, Cancel Guidance.  
TELEPHONE - BLUETOOTH  
SYSTEM  
Select OK to enter.  
5. Select Destination to confirm.  
cell phones with Bluetooth capability can  
communicate with the vehicle’s inbuilt  
telephone system.  
6. Once calculated, the screen displays  
Route 1. To view and select  
alternative routes, touch the 3 Route  
icon.  
The following procedure demonstrates  
how to connect the most popular brands  
of cell phone.  
7. Touch Start to commence navigation.  
Drive away following the voice  
guidance.  
Paring And Docking A Handset  
N
Quick  
Phone  
PHILADELPHIA  
Not  
Paired  
Vertu Ascent  
Nokia 623  
Pair & dock  
Delete  
Phone  
4
mi  
To pair & dock phone  
Enter (5616) on handset  
DELAWARE  
Cancel  
110 mi  
Menu  
WASHINGTON  
N Beechwood Street  
12 : 26 pm  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0451NAS  
JAG0455NAS  
1. Enable the cell phone’s Bluetooth  
function. Refer to the handset  
manufacturer’s instructions for  
guidance.  
Touch the audible repeat icon to hear the  
last voice instruction again. To mute voice  
guidance, go to the navigation Menu  
screen or, if the map is displayed, select  
Menu. Then select Auto Voice Guidance  
Off or On by touching the blue bar.  
2. Select Phone from the Home screen.  
3. If no phones have been Paired, No  
phone found will be displayed. Touch  
Yes to confirm a new phone search.  
The system will then search for  
Bluetooth enabled handsets in the  
vicinity.  
Upon arrival at your destination an audio  
announcement, and on-screen message  
will confirm your arrival.  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quick Start  
4. Once the system has recognised the  
Making a call  
handset, the name of the phone will  
appear on the phone list. Touch the  
Pair & Dock icon.  
1. With a paired and docked handset,  
select Phone from the Home screen.  
2. From the Digit Dial screen, enter the  
5. The screen will display a random  
four-digit code. Enter the code to the  
handset and follow any instructions  
displayed on the handset.  
number using the on-screen keypad.  
3.  
When the handset has been successfully  
docked to the system, the Digit Dial  
screen is displayed.  
Touch the phone icon on the screen,  
Downloading phonebook entries  
1. Select Phone from the Home screen.  
2. Touch Settings, then select Phone  
Options.  
or the call button on the steering  
wheel control.  
3. Select Phonebook from the Menu.  
The call duration will appear on the  
Touch-screen.  
4. Ensure that Auto Download is on. All  
the numbers in your cell phone will be  
transferred to the vehicle’s system the  
next time that the phone is connected  
to the system.  
Receiving A Call  
Phone  
01926648100  
Digit Dial  
Settings  
Options  
Names  
Last 10  
1
4
7
2
5
3
6
9
8
0
C
*
JAG0450G  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0452NAS  
To answer or end a call touch Accept on  
the screen, or press the call button on the  
steering wheel control.  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling Station Information  
Filling Station Information  
FUEL TYPE  
Unleaded 91 Octane  
Caution: This vehicle is not suitable for  
use with fuels containing more than 10  
per cent ethanol. Do not use E85 fuels  
(85 per cent ethanol content).  
Equipment necessary for the use of  
fuels containing more than 10 per cent  
ethanol is not fitted to this vehicle. If  
E85 fuels are used, serious engine and  
fuel system damage will occur.  
AVE FUEL  
A
MPG  
Fuel filling  
JAG0054NAS  
The filler flap is located on the right-hand  
side of the vehicle.  
When refuelling, ensure that the fuel  
nozzle rests on the bottom of the filler  
neck.  
Refit the fuel filler cap by twisting the filler  
cap clockwise until it clicks. Close the  
flap, which automatically locks shut.  
Incorrect replacement of the fuel filler cap  
may result in check engine warning  
indicator (malfunction warning indicator,  
MIL) illuminating.  
JAG0051L  
Press the fuel filler flap release, located on  
the driver’s knee bolster switchpack  
below the facia, see ‘FUEL FILLER FLAP’,  
page 52.  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling Station Information  
HOOD RELEASE  
TIRE PRESSURES  
Tire pressure label USA only  
JAG0056G  
JAG0059N  
Pull the release lever located below the  
facia on the left-hand side of the vehicle,  
see 234.  
The recommended tire pressures for all  
normal operating conditions, are shown  
on a label fixed to the pillar behind the  
driver’s door.  
UNDERHOOD TOP-UP  
Recommended engine oil.  
Castrol 5W-30 to Jaguar specification  
WSS M2C913 - A or B, see page 237.  
Windshield and headlamp washer  
reservoir.  
See page 239.  
Coolant system  
50% water 50% antifreeze, see page 238.  
JAG0057G  
Canada and Mexico only: The  
recommended tire pressures for all  
normal operating conditions, are shown  
on a label fixed to the end of the driver’s  
door.  
For your convenience you may wish to  
record the tire pressures in the boxes  
provided below. If you are unsure of the  
correct pressures, please contact your  
Jaguar Dealer.  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling Station Information  
If a warning appears one, or more, of your  
tires are significantly under-inflated. You  
should stop and check your tire pressures  
as soon as possible. They should be  
inflated to the recommended pressure. If  
warnings appear repeatedly, the cause  
must be investigated and rectified.  
FRONT  
Normal Driving  
Laden/High Speed  
REAR  
Check pressures when the tires are cold.  
Deflating a warm tire to the recommended  
cold inflation pressure, will result in  
dangerous under-inflation.  
Normal Driving  
Laden/High Speed  
Spare Wheel  
ULTRA HIGH PERFORMANCE  
TIRES  
Caution: Ultra high performance tires.  
This vehicle is equipped with an Ultra  
High Performance (UHP) tire and wheel  
combination designed to give  
maximum dry road performance with  
consideration for aquaplaning  
!
WARNING:  
When using tires other than those  
recommended by Jaguar, do not  
exceed the speed capacity  
resistance. UHP tires have  
recommended by the manufacturer.  
performance enhancing soft rubber  
tread compound. If driven aggressively  
they may suffer rapid tread wear and a  
shorter life than can be expected from  
other tire types. This wheel and tire  
combination is more susceptible to  
damage from road hazards.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING  
SYSTEM  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS), see page 267, monitors the  
pressures of the tires, providing a warning  
of low tire pressure.  
Do not use this combination for driving  
on snow or ice. High perfromance tires  
must be replaced with winter tires  
when weather conditions dictate.  
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE  
AVE EL  
Tires with an all season icon and or  
M+S marking have a level of winter  
performance and need not be  
replaced.  
A
MPG  
JAG0060NAS  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Chapter  
1
Warning symbols on the vehicle  
HEALTH AND SAFETY  
Caution: Do not remove any warning  
labels from the vehicle.  
!
WARNING:  
California Proposition 65:  
Engine exhaust, some of its  
constituents and certain vehicle  
components, contain or emit  
chemicals known to the State of  
California to cause cancer and birth  
defects or other reproductive harm.  
In addition, certain fluids contained in  
vehicles and certain products of  
component wear contain or emit  
chemicals known to the State of  
California to cause cancer and birth  
defects or other reproductive harm.  
JAG0063G  
These symbols advise you to read the  
handbook before touching this part of the  
vehicle or attempting adjustments of any  
kind.  
SYMBOLS GLOSSARY  
Warnings, cautions and notes  
Take particular note of WARNINGS,  
Cautions and Notes given throughout this  
handbook.  
!
WARNING:  
Warnings are displayed in this  
handbook to help avoid the risk of  
personal injury.  
Caution: Cautions are displayed in this  
handbook to reduce the possibility of  
damage to the vehicle.  
Note: Notes are used to help avoid  
difficulties in the operation of the vehicle.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Label locations  
PARTS AND ACCESSORIES  
Shown below are the main locations that  
contain vehicle warning and information  
labels:  
!
WARNING:  
Do not fit unapproved accessories or  
conversions, as they could affect the  
safety of the vehicle.  
3
Jaguar Cars Limited will not accept any  
liability for death, personal injury or  
damage to property which may occur  
as a direct result of fitment of  
non-approved conversions to Jaguar  
vehicles.  
2
1
2
4
Jaguar Cars Limited strongly advise  
against making any modifications to  
the suspension or steering systems.  
This could seriously affect the handling  
and stability of the vehicle leading to  
loss of control or roll-over.  
1
5
The use of non-genuine parts and  
accessories may invalidate the vehicle  
warranty.  
6
Genuine Jaguar parts and accessories  
Your Jaguar Dealer can supply you with  
genuine replacement parts and  
JAG0560G  
accessories which are fully approved to  
Jaguar’s original equipment specification.  
1. Vehicle certification.  
Air bag.  
Electrical accessories  
Child restraint.  
Tire placard.  
!
WARNING:  
2. Air conditioning.  
Emissions.  
Alterations to the electrical system,  
including the fitting of accessories not  
designed for this Jaguar, will cause  
damage to the electrical systems. This  
could result in a malfunction or fire. All  
accessory work should be entrusted to  
a Jaguar Dealer.  
3. Under hood warnings.  
4. Coolant warnings.  
5. Fuel warnings.  
6. Battery.  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Ground points  
How far, if at all, the driver was  
depressing the accelerator and/or the  
brake pedal.  
Caution: Underno circumstances must  
holes be drilled in the bodywork to  
accept ground terminals.  
How fast the vehicle was travelling.  
If an accessory needs to be connected to  
a ground point, it is advisable to consult a  
Jaguar Dealer.  
Where the driver was positioning the  
steering wheel.  
To access this information special  
equipment must be directly connected to  
the recording modules. Jaguar Cars  
Limited do not access event data  
recorder information without obtaining  
consent, unless pursuant to court order or  
where required by law enforcement, other  
government authorities or third parties  
acting with lawful authority.  
DATA RECORDING  
Service data recording  
Service data recorders in your vehicle are  
capable of collecting and storing  
diagnostic information about your vehicle.  
This potentially includes information  
about the performance or status of  
various systems and modules in the  
vehicle, such as engine, throttle, steering  
or brake systems.  
Other parties may seek to access the  
information independently of Jaguar Cars  
Limited.  
In order to properly diagnose and service  
your vehicle, Jaguar Cars Limited and  
service and repair facilities may access  
vehicle diagnostic information through a  
direct connection to your vehicle when  
diagnosing or servicing your vehicle.  
Event data recording  
Other modules in your vehicle - event data  
recorders - are capable of collecting and  
storing data during a crash or near crash  
event. The recorded information may  
assist in the investigation of such an  
event. The modules may record  
information about both the vehicle and  
the occupants, potentially including  
information such as:  
How various systems in your vehicle  
were operating.  
Whether or not the driver and  
passenger seat belts were buckled.  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Vehicle defects (U.S. Only)  
Vehicle defects (Canada only)  
If you believe that your vehicle has a  
defect which could cause a crash or could  
cause injury or death, you should  
If you believe that your vehicle has a  
defect which could cause a crash or could  
cause injury or death, you should  
immediately inform the National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in  
addition to notifying Jaguar Cars.  
immediately inform Transport Canada in  
addition to notifying Jaguar Cars.  
To contact Transport Canada, call their  
toll-free number 1-800-333-0510.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints,  
it may open an investigation, and if it finds  
that a safety defect exists in a group of  
vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy  
campaign.  
However, NHTSA cannot become  
involved in individual problems between  
you, your Dealer, or Jaguar Cars.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the  
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free  
at 1–888–327–4236 (TTY:  
1-800-424-9153); go to  
http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:  
Administrator,  
NHTSA,  
400 Seventh Street SW.,  
Washington, DC. 20590.  
To contact Jaguar Cars, call 1–800 4  
Jaguar.  
You can also obtain other information  
about motor safety from  
http://www.safercar.gov.  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys and Remote Controls  
Keys and Remote Controls  
Caution:  
PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION  
Remove all remote controls from  
the vehicle when it is left  
unattended. This will ensure the  
vehicle is left in a secure condition.  
The security system and entry to the  
vehicle are controlled by the Jaguar  
Smart Key. Both doors and the luggage  
compartment can be locked and  
unlocked using the remote control  
buttons.  
If a remote control is lost, a  
replacement can be obtained and  
programmed to the vehicle by a  
Jaguar Dealer. Notify a Jaguar  
Dealer as soon as a remote control  
is lost or stolen and have the  
remaining remote control(s)  
reprogrammed.  
The emergency key blade number is  
recorded on an attached label. Peel off  
the label and attach it to the designated  
area on the Security Card supplied in the  
vehicle literature pack. Keep the Security  
Card safe, but not in the vehicle.  
JAG0064G  
Keyless Entry is an enhancement of the  
Jaguar Smart Key. It allows entry to the  
vehicle without any button pressing.  
Full security integrity of the vehicle is still  
maintained, see Keyless Entry page 41.  
The remote control also allows the vehicle  
to be started without the use of an ignition  
key - Keyless Starting, see page 50.  
Two handsets, comprising of a  
transmitter body with a detachable metal  
emergency key blade are supplied.  
Separate emergency key blades are  
available from Jaguar Dealers.  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys and Remote Controls  
Note: Changing from central locking to  
USING THE REMOTE CONTROL  
two stage locking and back again can be  
carried out by pressing the lock and  
unlock buttons simultaneously for four  
seconds or via the touch-screen, see  
page 46. The directional indicators will  
flash twice to confirm that the change has  
been carried out.  
The remote handset,Jaguar Smart Key,  
allows the vehicle to be unlocked and the  
engine to be started without the use of an  
ignition key - Keyless Starting, see page  
50.  
4
3
2
Press and hold the button to globally  
open the vehicle windows, if enabled, see  
page 47. Press and hold opens all  
windows as well as the programmed door  
opening.  
1
5
6
2. Locks and arms the vehicle.  
First press (if vehicle is  
unlocked and disarmed:  
Locks all doors, luggage  
compartment and sets the alarm system.  
The direction indicators will flash once.  
7
JAG0065G  
3. Releases the luggage compartment  
lock.  
1. Unlocks and disarms the vehicle.  
Central unlocking  
When the vehicle alarm system  
is armed and the luggage  
compartment only is opened,  
the door and hood security is still active.  
The doors will remain locked and armed.  
See page 43.  
One press: Unlocks all doors  
and the luggage compartment.  
The direction indicators will flash twice.  
Two stage unlocking  
One press: Unlocks the driver’s door and  
the luggage compartment. The direction  
indicators will flash twice (in certain  
markets two audible warnings will be  
emitted).  
4. Activates the convenience headlamp  
feature.  
One press switches on  
headlamps. Theheadlampswill  
remain on for 25 seconds, or  
until the button is pressed again, or until  
the engine START/STOP button is  
pressed.  
Two presses (within three seconds):  
Unlocks the passenger door.  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys and Remote Controls  
5. Activates the panic alarm.  
Press the button three times  
within three seconds.  
The key blade operates the door lock on  
the left-hand side of the vehicle, the  
luggage compartment lock and glove  
compartment lock, see page 45.  
The alarm is stopped by:  
Care of the remote handset  
Pressing the button again three times  
within three seconds.  
Do not expose to extremes of heat, dust,  
humidity or allow contact with fluids. Do  
not leave the transmitter exposed to  
direct sunlight.  
Inserting the Jaguar Smart Key into  
the starter control unit, see page 37.  
The vehicle detecting a valid Jaguar  
Smart Key when the START/STOP  
button is pressed.  
Note: The panic alarm cannot be  
cancelled within the first 5 seconds of the  
alarm activating.  
6. Emergency key blade.  
To use the emergency key blade see  
page 45.  
7. Emergency key blade release button.  
JAG0075G  
To extract: press the release button and  
hold while withdrawing the key blade.  
To insert: press and hold the button and  
push the key blade into the Jaguar Smart  
Key transmitter housing.  
To extract: press the release button and  
hold while withdrawing the key blade.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys and Remote Controls  
Irregular remote control operation  
If difficulty is experienced with remote  
keyless entry, passive entry, passive  
starting or Jaguar Smart Key operation, it  
may be caused by:  
internal battery low voltage and  
therefore the battery should be  
replaced, see page 40, or  
1
high levels of localised external  
electrical interference e.g. radio  
transmitter.  
2
3
1
3
2
JAG0061G  
To remove the Jaguar Smart Key from the  
starter control unit:  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is at rest with  
the gear selector in the P position and  
the engine not running.  
JAG0066G  
Until the battery can be replaced, or until  
the vehicle is outside the local electrical  
interference zone, the Jaguar Smart Key  
must be inserted into the starter control  
unit.  
2. Carefully depress the Jaguar Smart  
Key and release. The key will eject into  
its rest position.  
3. Remove the Jaguar Smart Key from  
1. Lift the lid of the centre console  
the starter control unit.  
stowage compartment.  
Note: This is not a Jaguar Smart Key  
internal batteryrechargingprocedure. The  
battery is non-rechargeable.  
2. Slide open the cover of the starter  
control unit.  
3. Insert the Jaguar Smart Key into the  
recess with the emergency key  
release button facing forward.  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys and Remote Controls  
Message centre information displays  
Message  
Warning  
Light  
None  
Priority  
Indicator  
None  
Meaning  
SMART KEY NOT  
FOUND, PLEASE  
INSERT IN SLOT  
CHECK SMART KEY  
The Jaguar Smart Key has not  
been detected, insert into the  
starter control unit, see page 37.  
Check that the Jaguar Smart Key  
is in the vehicle.  
The Jaguar Smart Key detected  
by the in-vehicle systems is not  
the one belonging to the vehicle.  
Remove the Jaguar Smart Key  
from the starter control unit.  
None  
None  
None  
None  
WRONG SMART KEY  
FOUND  
REMOVE SMART KEY  
None  
None  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys and Remote Controls  
Jaguar Smart Key system transmitters  
1. Cabin front transmitter.  
2. Keyless vehicle module.  
3. Cabin rear transmitter.  
!
WARNING:  
Any person fitted with an implanted  
pacemaker should ensure that the  
pacemaker is kept at a distance of at  
least 22 cm (8.7 inches) away from any  
transmitter mounted in the vehicle.  
This is to avoid any possibility of  
interference between the system and  
pacemaker.  
4. Exterior door handle transmitters.  
5. Luggage compartment interior  
transmitter.  
6. Luggage compartment exterior  
transmitter.  
2
1
4
3
4
5
6
1
2
4
3
5
6
JAG0543G  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys and Remote Controls  
2. Remove the two side covers, one at a  
CHANGING THE REMOTE  
CONTROL BATTERY  
time, by inserting a small, flat blade,  
screwdriver between the cover and  
body and lightly twist the screwdriver.  
Battery renewal  
3. Insert a small, flat bladed, screwdriver  
between the two body halves of the  
remote control. Apply light pressure  
to the screwdriver and separate the  
two halves.  
1
4. Remove the printed circuit board,  
taking care not to touch the battery  
terminals. Remove the old battery and  
dispose of it safely.  
2
5. Fit a new battery cell, type CR2032  
(available from your Jaguar Dealer),  
with the side marked with the positive  
symbol (+) downwards in the battery  
receptacle. Avoid touching the new  
battery as moisture/oil from the  
2
fingers can reduce the life of the  
battery and corrode the contacts.  
3
Refit the parts in the reverse order  
ensuring that they click securely into  
place.  
4
5
JAG0555G  
When the battery needs renewing there  
will be a significant decrease in the  
effective range of the key transmitter and  
the message SMART KEY BATTERY  
LOW is displayed on the message centre.  
To renew the battery, follow the  
procedure below:  
1. Remove the key blade from the  
Jaguar Smart Key, see page 36.  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
Locks  
Two stage unlocking: Access to the  
KEYLESS ENTRY  
vehicle is via the first door handle  
operated. The other door can be opened  
by releasing the internal door lock or via  
operating the exterior door handle with a  
Jaguar Smart Key present.  
Note: Changing from central locking to  
two stage locking and back again can be  
simply carried out by pressing the lock  
and unlock buttons simultaneously for  
four seconds. The directional indicators  
will flash twice to confirm the change.  
Jaguar Smart Key check  
When the last open door is closed, the  
vehicle will perform a search of the vehicle  
interior for the Jaguar Smart Key. If one is  
not found a message SMART KEY NOT  
FOUND, PLEASE INSERT IN SLOT will  
be displayed for four seconds on the  
message centre. This is to alert the driver  
that the Jaguar Smart Key may have been  
inadvertently removed from the vehicle.  
JAG0068G  
The Keyless Entry function operates in  
the following manner:  
Central locking:  
1. As a door handle is operated, the  
vehicle emits a search signal.  
2. As long as the Jaguar Smart Key is  
within approximately 1.0m (3 feet 3  
inches) of the operated door handle,  
the signal will be acknowledged.  
LOCKING AND UNLOCKING  
Note: The Jaguar Smart Key requires  
only to be on the driver’s person or in  
a bag or a non-metallic briefcase; it  
does not require to be exposed or  
handled.  
!
WARNING:  
The door windows partially lower and  
raise automatically when the door is  
opened and closed. Keep fingers away  
from the windows when closing the  
door. Closing an electrically operated  
window on fingers, hands or any  
vulnerable part of the body, can result  
in serious injury.  
3. The vehicle accepts the valid  
response and allows access via either  
door. The direction indicators will  
flash twice (in certain markets two  
audible warnings will be emitted).  
Note: It will not be possible to lock the  
vehicle if any door, hood or luggage  
compartment is ajar or the inertia switch  
has been tripped, see page 223. An  
audible warning will be emitted.  
Note: You are unlikely to notice a  
time lag during this momentary  
process.  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
Convenience Mode  
Anti-slam locking  
As the door is opened, the vehicle’s  
electrical system initiates the  
This feature helps prevent locking the  
remote handset in the vehicle.  
convenience mode. The following  
systems become functional:  
If either the driver’s or passenger’s door is  
open and an attempt is made to lock the  
doors using the interior locking levers, the  
doors will not lock, due to a mechanical  
inhibitor.  
memory  
seat and steering column adjustment  
interior and exterior lighting  
message centre  
The vehicle can be locked using the  
touch-screen lock, the remote handset  
(when outside the vehicle) when all the  
doors are closed.  
cigar lighter and power socket.  
Door external lock operation - with  
Keyless Entry  
Door external lock operation - without  
Keyless Entry  
Note: The keyless locking system will only  
activate if the remote handset is outside  
the vehicle.  
1
2
JAG0069L  
JAG0520G  
To lock the vehicle and set alarm  
Press the remote control lock button 1 or  
use the emergency key blade 2, see page  
45.  
1. Press the button on the door handle  
once, or;  
2. Use the Jaguar Smart Key.  
Note: The vehicle will not lock  
automatically.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
Door interior lock operation  
Luggage compartment locking and  
unlocking  
1
2
JAG0071L  
To lock: Press the door release lever  
inwards to lock both doors and luggage  
compartment.  
To unlock: Pull the door release lever.  
Drive-away door locking  
This feature locks all the doors and  
luggage compartment if they are  
unlocked when the gear selector is  
moved out of the P position and the  
vehicle is moving forward at the set speed  
of above 7 km/h (5 mph).  
4
3
JAG0073L  
All vehicles  
Drive-away locking can be disabled or  
reinstated by use of the touch-screen, if  
required, see page 46.  
The luggage compartment can be opened  
by:  
Pressing the luggage compartment  
release switch 1 on the facia  
switchpack.  
Pressing the luggage compartment  
release button 2 on the remote  
handset.  
Note: If the vehicle is armed the alarm  
will not activate, but will re-arm when  
the luggage compartment lid is closed  
again.  
With the vehicle unlocked, press the  
release button 3 on the luggage  
compartment lid. However, it will be  
inhibited if the valet mode is set.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
The key blade can be used to open  
Luggage compartment emergency  
release  
the luggage compartment release  
lock 4, located behind the number  
plate, but this will cause the alarm to  
sound.  
1
Caution: If the luggage compartment is  
opened after the driver and passenger  
doors are locked, ensure the Jaguar  
Smart Key remains outside the vehicle  
when it is closed again.  
Vehicles without Keyless Entry  
If the Jaguar Smart Key is inadvertently  
left inside the vehicle, you will be locked  
out. You should contact your Jaguar  
Dealer.  
2
Vehicles with Keyless Entry  
Caution: If the Jaguar Smart Key is  
inadvertently left inside the vehicle, an  
audible alarm will sound and the  
luggage compartment lid will re-open  
after three seconds.  
JAG0062N  
Your vehicle is equipped with a  
mechanical interior luggage compartment  
release handle that provides a means of  
escape for children and adults in the  
event they become locked inside the  
luggage compartment.  
Note: If the Jaguar Smart Key is placed in  
a metal container, it will not be detected.  
All Jaguar Smart Keys must be removed  
from the vehicle before locking.  
Adults are advised to familiarise  
themselves with the operation and  
location of the release handle.  
The T-shaped handle is located on the  
luggage compartment lid, coupe 1 and  
convertible 2.  
To open the luggage compartment lid  
from the inside, pull the T-shaped handle  
and push up the lid. The material that the  
handle is made of will glow for hours in the  
darkness of the luggage compartment  
following brief exposure to ambient light.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
Ensure that the T-shaped handle is firmly  
returned to its stowed position after use.  
Push up and twist the key blade to release  
the cover retaining clips. Insert the key  
blade into the exposed lock.  
Note: Ensure that the emergency key  
blade is kept safely at all times.  
!
WARNING:  
Keep vehicle doors and the luggage  
compartmentlocked andkeepkeys  
out of a child’s reach. Unsupervised  
children could lock themselves in  
an open compartment and risk  
injury. Children should be taught  
not to play in vehicle.  
To lock the vehicle  
Turn the key blade towards the front of  
the vehicle and release.  
This will lock the doors and the luggage  
compartment, but will not arm the vehicle.  
Unlocking  
On hot days, the temperature in the  
luggage compartment and the  
vehicle interior can rise very  
quickly. Exposure of people or  
animals to these high temperatures  
for even a short time can cause  
death or serious heat-related  
injuries, including brain damage.  
Small children are particularly at  
risk.  
To unlock the vehicle  
Turn the key blade towards the rear of the  
vehicle and release. This unlocks the  
left-hand side door and the luggage  
compartment and turns on the interior  
lights for two minutes at ¾ brightness.  
When the vehicle is unlocked in this  
manner, and a door is opened, this will  
activate the full alarm. To disarm the  
vehicle, press the Jaguar Smart Key  
unlock button or stow it in the starter  
control unit, see page 37, or press the  
engine START/STOP button.  
Emergency key blade operation  
The direction indicators give two flashes  
(in certain markets two audible warnings  
will be given).  
Valet mode  
Valet mode allows the vehicle to be  
parked by a parking attendant who can  
lock the vehicle after parking, but cannot  
open the luggage or glove compartments.  
The key blade is used to lock the glove  
compartment. The touch-screen sets the  
valet mode for securing the luggage  
compartment, seePROGRAMMINGTHE  
REMOTE CONTROL on page -46.  
JAG0076G  
Remove the left-hand door handle key  
lock cover by inserting the key blade into  
the rectangular hole on the underside of  
the cover.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
Selecting drive-away locking  
From the main Home touch-screen  
menu, select Vehicle:  
PROGRAMMING THE REMOTE  
CONTROL  
The remote handset, Jaguar Smart Key,  
and various features of the vehicle  
security system can be programmed to  
your individual requirements by use of the  
touch-screen.  
Vehicle  
Security  
2 stage unlock Off  
Intrusion/tilt Off  
On  
On  
Parking  
The programmable features are as  
follows:  
Valet mode  
drive-away locking  
central or two stage locking  
sensor override  
12 : 26 pm  
window global open or close, passive  
entry vehicles only  
Vehicle  
valet key mode.  
Security  
Drive away  
Off  
On  
On  
On  
Parking  
locking  
Off  
Global open  
Valet mode  
Global close Off  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0526NAS  
1. Select Veh. settings.  
2. The Security button is selected  
automatically as the default.  
3. Scroll down to - Drive away locking -  
and select either On or Off.  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
Selecting central or two stage locking  
Valet mode  
From the main Home touch-screen  
menu, select Vehicle:  
From the main Home touch-screen  
menu, select Vehicle:  
1. Select Veh. settings.  
Vehicle  
2. The Security button is selected  
Security  
automatically as the default.  
2 stage unlock Off  
Intrusion/tilt Off  
On  
On  
Parking  
3. Select Valet mode.  
Valet mode  
4. Enter a four digit Personal  
Identification Number (PIN)  
(personally chosen) by touching the  
digit screen pad. On completion  
touch the OK button. The screen  
indicates that the PIN has been  
accepted by displaying Valet on. If  
you wish to cancel the PIN, touch the  
C button at any time during entering  
the number.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0525NAS  
1. Select Veh. settings.  
2. The Security button is selected  
automatically as the default.  
3. Select: - 2 stage unlock - On or Off.  
Vehicle  
C
Valet off - enter pin  
Security  
1
2
3
Parking  
Valet mode  
4
6
7
8
9
0
OK  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0079NAS  
Using the key blade, lock the glove  
box.  
The luggage compartment is now  
securely locked in the valet mode.  
On exiting and securing the vehicle,  
hand the Jaguar Smert Key, less the  
key blade, to the attendant.  
Note: Ensure that the emergency key  
blade is kept safely at all times.  
De-selecting valet mode: When entry  
into the vehicle has been gained, access  
the Valet mode screen.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks  
Vehicle  
C
Valet on - enter pin  
Security  
1
2
3
Parking  
Valet mode  
4
6
7
8
9
0
OK  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0080NAS  
1. Enter your four digit PIN and touch the  
OK button. The screen will indicate  
that your PIN has been accepted by  
displaying Valet off.  
2. The luggage compartment will return  
to the previously set security  
requirement.  
3. Unlock the glove box using the key  
blade.  
4. Insert the key blade into the Jaguar  
Smart Key.  
Note: If the PIN number has been  
forgotten, the luggage compartment can  
be unlocked by using the key blade in the  
luggage compartment lock. This will  
cancel the valet mode, see page 43.  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alarm  
Alarm  
Remote headlight convenience  
By pressing the remote handset  
transmitter button with the dipped  
headlight symbol once, the headlights will  
come on for 25 seconds, unless the  
headlight button is pressed again, or if the  
engine START/STOP button key pressed.  
ARMING THE ALARM  
Some items may not be available, contact  
your Jaguar Dealer if you are unsure.  
Passive arming of the automatic alarm  
system, can be programmed by a Jaguar  
Dealer. This ensures that the security  
system arms itself 30 seconds after the  
doors, hood and luggage compartment  
are closed following removal of the  
remote handset from the vehicle.  
DISARMING THE ALARM  
Using the remote control  
See page 35 and 41.  
Standard alarm features cover the  
perimeter sensing of hood, doors and  
luggage compartment.  
Using the key blade  
See page 45.  
Note: Passive arming does not lock the  
doors.  
PANIC ALARM  
Alarms and audible signals  
Note: In certain markets, legislation  
prohibits the use of audible confirmation  
signals.  
Audible signals  
Two audible warnings (error signal) will  
sound if an attempt is made to lock the  
vehicle if a door, hood or luggage  
compartment is not fully closed.  
JAG0081G  
When in or near the vehicle, the panic  
alarm can be set off to deter a possible  
offender.  
Full alarm  
Once armed, any of the following  
circumstances will create a full alarm  
state, sound the siren or horns and flash  
the direction indicators:  
Pressing the panic button on the remote  
handset transmitter three times within  
three seconds will activate the panic  
alarm.  
opening a door, luggage  
compartment (except with remote  
handset) or hood  
The alarm is stopped by inserting the  
remote handset in the starter control unit  
or by pressing the panic button on the key  
transmitter three times within three  
seconds or holding the panic button  
down for three seconds.  
using a remote handset in the starter  
control unit which is not programmed  
to the vehicle.  
Note: The panic alarm is not functional if  
the ignition system is ON.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Starting the Engine  
Chapter  
2
When pressing the engine START/STOP  
button to start the engine, if the security  
status light, on the top surface of the  
instrument panel, remains flashing, a fault  
condition is indicated. Seek qualified  
assistance as soon as possible.  
KEYLESS STARTING  
!
WARNING:  
Before starting the engine, check the  
parkbrake is ON and the gear selector  
is in position P.  
Ignition system ON, non-engine start  
To turn on the ignition system without  
starting the engine, press the  
START/STOP button without pressing the  
brake pedal. All systems will become  
functional.  
Rolling re-start  
If the engine is switched off while the  
vehicle is moving, a rolling re-start can be  
initiated by selecting neutral, N, and  
pressing the engine START/STOP button.  
JAG0503N  
With the brake pedal depressed, press  
the START/STOP button to start the  
engine. All systems will become  
functional.  
SWITCHING OFF THE ENGINE  
Caution: Never switch OFF the engine  
whilst the vehicle is in motion.  
With the gear selector in position P, press  
the engine START/STOP button. The  
engine will stop and the electrical system  
will return to the convenience mode. The  
audio, telephone and touch-screen  
systems will revert to stand-by mode.  
Pressing the START/STOP button again  
will activate the systems.  
Note: If the fuel system inertia switch has  
been tripped, the ignition system will be  
isolated, see page 223.  
If the engine persistently fails to start,  
press the START/STOP button to turn the  
ignition system back to convenience  
mode. Slowly depress the accelerator  
pedal fully, hold it in this position and  
press the START/STOP button with the  
brake pedal applied, the engine will start  
to crank. Release the accelerator pedal  
when the engine starts.  
Note: If the Jaguar Smart Key is placed in  
the door pocket it will be outside the  
range of the sensors when the door is  
opened.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Immobiliser  
Engine Immobiliser  
CODED KEYS  
This vehicle is equipped with a Passive  
Anti-Theft System (PATS) which prevents  
it from being driven away by an  
unauthorised person.  
A sophisticated decoding process is used  
to validate the Jaguar Smart Key. The  
engine can only be started by the key that  
is programmed to the vehicle electronic  
systems.  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving Hints  
Driving Hints  
Brakes  
RUNNING-IN  
To ensure that brake pads reach their  
Apart from a few precautionary  
optimum wear and performance  
condition, usually within 480 kilometres  
(300 miles), observe the following points  
are recommended.  
recommendations, there are no strict  
running-in procedures for this vehicle.  
By observing the following advisory  
precautions you will ensure maximum  
engine, transmission and brake life for  
your vehicle:  
Where possible, avoid heavy braking  
as this can result in damage to the  
brake pads and discs.  
Engine  
Avoid prolonged use of the brakes, for  
example, when descending severe  
gradients.  
Allow the engine to reach operating  
temperature before operating at  
engine speeds over 3500 rev/min.  
Frequent light application of the  
brakes is desirable. This helps to fully  
bed-in the brake pads.  
Vary the speed frequently.  
From 1500 kilometres (940 miles)  
onwards, gradually increase  
Final drive unit  
performance of the vehicle up to the  
permitted maximum speed.  
During the first 1500 kilometers (940  
miles):  
Engine oil consumption  
Avoid full throttle applications and do  
not exceed 190 km/h (120 mph).  
A certain amount of oil consumption is  
normal. The rate of consumption will  
depend on the following:  
Observe the national speed limits in  
the country in which you are travelling.  
The quality and viscosity of the oil.  
Climatic conditions.  
Do not participate in motor racing  
events, test track days, sports driving  
schools or similar for the first 8000  
kilometers (4975 miles), also see page  
161.  
The speed at which the engine is  
being operated.  
Road conditions.  
Drivers should expect above normal  
consumption when the engine is new, and  
after running-in if high speeds are  
sustained.  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Steering Wheel  
Steering Wheel  
3. Move the switch up or down to adjust  
ADJUSTING THE STEERING  
WHEEL  
tilt.  
Three steering wheel positions may be  
stored and recalled by the driver position  
memory system, refer to Memory Setting  
on page 139.  
The message centre will indicate which  
switch position has been selected by  
displaying the message COLUMN  
ADJUST or COLUMN ADJUST AUTO.  
Entry and exit mode  
Entry and exit mode provides automatic  
movement of the steering column to allow  
easier entry to or exit from the vehicle.  
Entry and exit mode is selected by setting  
the steering column adjustment switch to  
the AUTO position 2.  
Exit: - If the ignition system is in the  
convenience mode position and the  
driver’s door is opened, the steering  
column will move to the uppermost tilt  
position, unless already in that position.  
JAG0040G  
!
WARNING:  
Entry: - When the door is closed and the  
Start button is pressed, the steering  
column will return to the previous  
position.  
Do not adjust the steering wheel whilst  
driving.  
Caution: Do not use steering wheel  
mounted security devices since  
movement of the steering wheel in  
entry or exit mode could result in  
damage to the vehicle (e.g. the  
windshield) or possible injury to the  
occupant.  
Notes on entry and exit mode  
operation  
If the steering column switch is moved  
away from AUTO whilst the steering  
column is tilted away, the steering  
column will move back to its previous  
position when the driver’s door is  
closed and the Start button is  
pressed.  
The steering wheel can be adjusted for tilt  
and reach.  
1. Turn the switch to the COLUMN or  
AUTO position 1.  
If the steering column is adjusted  
during entry and exit operation,  
steering column movement will stop.  
2. Move the switch forwards or  
backwards to adjust reach.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Steering Wheel  
HORN  
HEATED STEERING WHEEL  
The heated steering wheel is activated via  
the touch-screen main Home screen.  
Home  
Audio  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
JAG0113G  
71.5 F F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
TP  
The dual tone horn is operated by  
pressing the centre pad on the steering  
wheel.  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
The horn also operates as a warning horn  
if the vehicle alarm system is activated.  
JAG0115NAS  
With the engine running, press the  
steering wheel icon for heating either ON  
or OFF.  
Auto  
Climate  
Auto  
External  
62  
Auto  
F
Settings  
Econ  
Left  
Right  
71.5  
F
7
F
Climate  
Temp. sync.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0117NAS  
The heated steering wheel can also be  
activated via the Climate Control main  
screen by pressing the steering wheel  
icon for heating either ON or OFF while  
the engine is running.  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Steering Wheel  
AUDIO CONTROL  
CRUISE CONTROL  
1
2
1
4
3
3
2
JAG0034G  
JAG0035G  
The cruise (speed) control system can be  
used by the driver to maintain a selected  
vehicle speed40 km/h (25 mph) for 2.5-  
and 3.0-litre vehicles, and 28 km/h (18  
mph) for 2.0-litre petrol and diesel  
vehicles, without the driver having to use  
the accelerator.  
1. Increase or decrease volume.  
2. Cycle through preset radio stations or  
next CD track. A short press will seek  
up or down to next preset station or  
next CD track. Press and hold for two  
seconds to select next strong radio  
station or next CD.  
Controls on the steering wheel allow the  
driver manual control of the system.  
3. Cycle through radio FM, AM and CD  
changer. Press and hold for two  
seconds to select Phone Ready  
mode.  
1. SPEED ADJUSTMENT CONTROL:  
The thumb wheel is used to engage  
cruise control initially. It is also used to  
increase or decrease the set speed.  
4. Select mute or answer phone call  
when ringing.  
2. CANCEL: cancels cruise control but  
retains the set speed in memory.  
3. RESUME: engages cruise control  
after it has been cancelled.  
For more information about cruise  
control, see page 169.  
For information about adaptive cruise  
control, see page 173.  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wipers and Washers  
Wipers and Washers  
Intermittent wipe  
WINDSHIELD WIPERS  
The windshield wipers and screen wash  
functions are controlled by the right-hand  
column stalk and only operate with the  
ignition system ON.  
Note:  
Do not operate the wipers on a dry  
screen.  
In freezing or very hot conditions,  
ensure that the blades are not stuck to  
the glass.  
In winter, remove any snow or ice from  
around the arms and blades, including  
the wiped area of the of the windshield  
and the heater air intakes. If the wiper  
blades have stuck to the glass, an  
electronic cut-out may temporarily  
prevent the wiper motor from  
JAG0124G  
When intermittent wipe 2 is selected, the  
delay between wipes can be varied by  
turning the rotary collar 5 to the required  
delay position. Rain sensor wiper  
operation is selected by turning the collar  
to AUTO.  
operating. If this occurs, switch OFF  
the wiper and the ignition system.  
Clear the obstruction and try again.  
Note: If configured, the delay period for  
each collar position (excluding AUTO),  
automatically increases and decreases  
with vehicle speed.  
4
3
5
Flick wipe  
2
1
JAG0050G  
The stalk functions are as follows when  
placed in the shown positions:  
JAG0123G  
Pull the stalk towards the steering wheel  
for a single wipe. Holding the column  
switch in this position will operate the  
wipers continuously at normal speed until  
released.  
1. Windshield wipers off and parked.  
2. Intermittent wipe.  
3. Normal speed wipe.  
4. Fast speed wipe.  
5. Intermittent wipe rotary collar.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wipers and Washers  
Speed dependant mode  
Note: When starting a journey with a wet  
windshield, the rain sensing wipers may  
not operate immediately when the ignition  
system is switched ON. Therefore, a flick  
wipe should be used to clear the  
If speed dependant mode is configured,  
the operation of all wiper modes will be  
affected by the vehicle speed.  
Speed dependant mode becomes active  
when the wipers are operating and the  
vehicle speed exceeds 10 km/h (6 mph). If  
the vehicle subsequently becomes  
stationary, the wiper automatically  
change to the next lowest operating  
speed. When the vehicle starts moving  
again, the original wiper speed setting is  
automatically restored.  
windshield of any moisture.  
Note: Some States require headlights to  
be ON when wipers are in use.  
CHECKING THE WIPER  
BLADES  
Windshield wiper blades – clean and  
inspect  
Speed dependant mode can be  
configured at your Jaguar Dealer.  
Grease, silicone and gasoline-based  
products impair the blade’s wiping  
capability.  
RAIN SENSOR  
Caution:  
Lift the wiper blades clear of the  
windshield and wipe the blades with a  
clean, soft cloth moistened with water to  
which a mild liquid detergent has been  
added.  
Ensure that AUTO is not selected  
when entering a car wash or  
damage to the wiper blades or arms  
can occur as they will operate in the  
car wash.  
If signs of hardness or cracking in the  
rubber are found, or if the wipers leave  
streaks or unwiped areas on the  
windshield during use, then the wiper  
blades should be replaced.  
During frosty conditions ensure  
that AUTO is not selected before  
operating the ignition system as  
damage to the wiper blades can  
occur when the windshield is  
frozen.  
Note: The wiper arms have a restricted lift  
of 10 degrees.  
Use Jaguar Screen Clean Paste to  
remove contamination from the  
windshield to ensure effective wiping or if  
smearing or juddering becomes evident.  
When AUTO (turn the rotary collar 5 to  
AUTO) and intermittent wipe 2 are  
selected, the wipers will automatically  
operate when rain falls on to the  
A more aggressive cleaning agent may be  
required to remove stubborn  
contamination. You should contact a  
Jaguar Dealer for advice.  
windshield, or when moisture is present.  
For the wipers to operate, the ignition  
system must be in the ON position.  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wipers and Washers  
CHANGING THE WIPER  
WINDSHIELD WASHERS  
BLADES  
Only fit replacement wiper blades that are  
identical to the original specification.  
JAG0125G  
Program wash and wipe  
Timed jet function: If timed jet function is  
configured, the windshield washer jets  
(located on the wiper arms) only spray on  
the up stroke of the wiper arms. This  
function can be configured at your Jaguar  
Dealer.  
With the stalk in the OFF or intermittent  
position, the program wash and wipe  
sequence is activated by pushing the  
button on the end of the column switch.  
JAG0461L  
Short press: The wipers will perform five  
normal speed wipes, followed by a drip  
wipe. The washer jets will spray on the  
first two wipes.  
Lift the locking tab to release the blade  
assembly and slide the wipe assembly off  
the end of the wiper arm. Carefully  
replace the wiper arm assembly to its  
stowed position.  
Extended press: The wipers and  
washers will operate continuously at  
normal speed until the button is released.  
When released, the wipers will complete  
their current wipe and then complete  
three further wipes, followed by a drip  
wipe.  
To replace the wiper blade, position the  
wiper arm into the aperture in the middle  
of the new blade assembly and fully  
locate the blade into the wiper arm. Push  
the lock tab firmly into position so that the  
wiper blade is locked into the wiper arm.  
Drip wipe: If drip wipe is configured,  
following completion of the program wash  
and wipe cycles, the wipers will pause for  
four seconds then complete a drip wipe to  
clear any remaining drips from the  
windshield.  
This function can be configured at your  
Jaguar Dealer.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wipers and Washers  
Washer  
HEADLAMP WASHERS  
If normal or fast wipe is selected, pressing  
the program wash and wipe button will  
operate the washer jets.  
Note: Telescopic headlamp powerwash  
units are contained within the front  
headlamp units.  
Short press: The washer jets spray for  
two wipes.  
If the ignition system is in the ON position,  
dipped beam headlamps are switched  
ON and there is sufficient fluid in the  
washer reservoir, pressing the program  
wash and wipe button will also operate  
the headlamp powerwash; directing two  
short bursts of washer fluid onto the  
headlamps.  
Extended press: The washer jets  
spray until the button is released or a  
10 second timer has elapsed.  
Note: If the button is pressed during the  
up-stroke of the wipers, the washer jets  
may spray for the completion of that wipe,  
prior to spraying for the required number  
of wipes or duration.  
After the first headlight powerwash  
operation, the headlight powerwash will  
operate on every fourth press of the  
program wash and wipe button, provided  
that the headlamps are still switched ON  
and a 10 minute timer has elapsed since  
the last headlamp powerwash.  
If the rotary collar is set to AUTO, the  
wipers will operate until no moisture is  
detected.  
Note: If the low washer fluid warning is  
ON, the windshield wipers will not operate  
when program wash and wipe is activated  
even though there may be washer fluid  
remaining in the reservoir and sprayed  
onto the screen. This is to prevent  
damage to the blades, scratching of the  
glass, or smearing dirt across the screen.  
Flick wiper, normal or fast operation, can  
be selected to clear any spray from the  
windshield.  
Note:  
The powerwash sequence is reset  
when the headlamps or ignition is  
turned OFF and ON again.  
The headlamp powerwash function is  
inhibited when the low washer fluid  
warning is on.  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Lighting  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
Active front lighting system (AFL)  
100  
Active Front Lighting (AFL) is designed to  
give the driver improved visibility under  
varying driving conditions.  
3
50  
1
4
JAG0128L  
They also react dynamically in the vertical  
plane to the vehicle’s braking or  
acceleration to maximise headlamp  
performance.  
2
The units operate when the engine is  
running and the master lighting switch set  
to headlamps, see page 71, or AUTO, if  
the ambient light has fallen below a preset  
level.  
The system takes inputs from the  
vehicle’s road speed, steering angle to  
determine the amount of horizontal  
swivel. The amount of swivel is highest at  
low speed, manoeuvring speeds and  
reduces as speed increases.  
JAG0126L  
The illustration shows the light spread of a  
vehicle NOT FITTED with AFL 1 and a  
vehicle FITTED with AFL 2.  
If reverse gear is selected, the lamps  
return to the central position and the  
swivelling capability is disabled.  
The main light source consists of  
bi-functional (high and low beam) xenon  
projector units.  
When the engine is started, the  
headlamps can be seen to swivel as they  
initiate a self-calibration cycle for a few  
seconds.  
The projector units are swivelled left or  
right to improve the light spread on bends  
in the road.  
Bi-Xenon lights 3 provide significantly  
improved visibility over halogen lights 4.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Cornering or static bending lamps  
The system switches on the lamp if it has  
received an input from the vehicle’s  
direction indicator. As the system is  
ignition based, the lamp will not stay on  
even if the vehicle is parked with the  
direction indicator lever in the operating  
position.  
Additional lighting comes from the  
cornering or static bending lamps which  
are angled outwards from the centre line  
of the vehicle.  
These lamps broaden the beam of the  
headlamps when cornering during normal  
night driving.  
Only the lamp on the same side as the  
operating direction indicator illuminates.  
Note: Excessive rotation of the steering  
wheel while the ignition system is in the  
OFF position may cause incorrect  
1
calibration of the static bending lamps. In  
extreme situations the lamps may operate  
earlier than previously experienced.  
However, correct calibration of the lamps  
is automatically re-established within 30  
seconds of the vehicle being driven.  
2
JAG0130L  
The illustration shows the light spread of a  
vehicle NOT FITTED 1 with static bending  
lamps and a vehicle FITTED 2 with static  
bending lamps.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
With the ignition in convenience mode,  
LIGHTING CONTROL  
see page 42, this position switches on low  
beam headlamps in addition to the lights  
switched on in sidelamp position.  
Note: If the ignition system is OFF and the  
lamps are left ON, the message centre will  
display LIGHTS ON.  
The left-hand column stalk switch has two  
positions for controlling the high beam.  
The exterior lamps are controlled by the  
left-hand column stalk switch.  
The rotary collar on the stalk has three  
positions for turning the exterior lamps on  
or off and positions for autolamps and exit  
delay. These are:  
OFF  
JAG0135G  
Pulling the switch towards the steering  
wheel and releasing causes the high  
beam to flash on and off. The high beam  
can be flashed at any time when the  
switch is pulled and will remain ON for as  
long as the switch is held.  
JAG0132G  
All exterior lamps OFF (except vehicles  
provided with daylight running lamps).  
Sidelamps  
JAG0133G  
JAG0136G  
Switches on front sidelamps, tail, number  
plate and any other marker lamps  
required by local legislation. When the  
external lamps are ON the instruments  
will also be lit.  
The second position is to switch high  
beam headlamps ON. With the ignition  
system ON, see page 50, first select low  
beam lamps, and then push the column  
light switch away from the steering wheel.  
Headlamps  
The blue warning light on the instrument  
cluster and high beam headlamps will  
come ON.  
To turn high beam OFF, pull the column  
switch towards the steering wheel to  
return to low beam.  
JAG0134G  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Note: If low beam is switched OFF, the  
Autolamps with Exit Delay  
rotary controls switch is moved, with high  
beam still activated, both low and high  
beam will be extinguished. Both low and  
high beam will illuminate if low beam is  
turned on again.  
Autolamps  
JAG0138G  
JAG0137G  
Three settings on the rotary collar set the  
time that the headlamps will remain on  
after the driver’s door has closed:  
A light sensor control, mounted on the  
front of the facia, monitors exterior light  
levels and automatically switches the  
sidelamps and low beam headlamps ON  
or OFF.  
30 seconds.  
60 seconds.  
120 seconds.  
The ignition system must be ON for full  
automatic light operation.  
The message centre will display the  
change set delay AUTOLAMP DELAY  
X:XX or AUTOLAMP DELAY OFF when  
the autolamp delay function has been  
turned OFF.  
When light fades towards dusk, the  
sidelamps and headlamps will switch ON  
automatically.  
At dawn, as light increases, the sidelamps  
and headlamps switch OFF automatically.  
Note: If the light switch rotary collar is in  
the AUTO position there will be no exit  
delay and the headlamps will turn off  
when the ignition system is OFF.  
Do not cover the sensor and keep the  
windshield clean. Obstructing the light in  
this area of the sensor may lead to  
unwanted operation of the sidelamps and  
headlamps.  
Door guard and puddle lamps  
Door guard lamps are fitted to each door  
to give warning of an open door to  
passing vehicles. Puddle lamps illuminate  
the step out area at night.  
Windshield wiper detection  
(This function only operates when  
autolamps is selected.) The sidelamps  
and headlamps will switch ON  
automatically if the windshield wipers are  
switched ON for 20 seconds or more.  
Once the windshield wipers are switched  
OFF, the sidelamps and headlamps will  
automatically switch OFF two minutes  
later.  
Each lamp comes on automatically when  
the door is opened. If the door is left open  
the lamps remain on for approximately 15  
minutesafterreturningfromconvenience  
mode to power off.  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Daylight running lights  
(Canada only)  
Press the centre switch 1 in the front roof  
console to turn the courtesy lights, puddle  
lights and footwell lights on. A second  
press turns the lights off. The lights also  
operate to illuminate the vehicle interior  
when a door is opened.  
In certain countries it is a legal  
requirement for the lights to be on during  
the hours of daylight.  
With the rotary collar in the OFF position,  
low beam headlamps, sidelamps, tail,  
license plate lamps and, where fitted, side  
marker lamps will switch on automatically  
with the following conditions:  
The interior courtesy light and footwell  
lights can be de-activated by pressing  
the centre switch for more than two  
seconds. The courtesy light will flash,  
then switch OFF.  
The ignition system is ON.  
The courtesy light and footwell light will  
come on again when the light switch is  
pressed again for more than two seconds.  
The vehicle gear selector out of park.  
The parkbrake is not applied (is  
released).  
The centre console area is illuminated by  
a small light from the overhead console 3.  
This is on whenever the sidelights are on  
and can be controlled by the dimmer  
switch.  
Cabin Lighting  
3
Reading lighting  
The reading and map lights are turned on  
and off by individual switches, 2 on the  
front overhead console.  
2
1
2
JAG0143G  
Illuminated entry and exit  
The interior lights will gradually illuminate  
when a door is opened and go out when  
the engine is started or approximately 30  
seconds after the last door is closed. If  
any door is left open, the lights will fade  
off after approximately 15 minutes after  
returning from convenience mode to  
power OFF.  
1. Courtesy light and footwell lights.  
2. Left and right-hand reading and map  
lights.  
3. Centre console illumination.  
Interior lighting comprises, front overhead  
courtesy lights, two front reading and  
map lights and front puddle lights. Vanity  
mirrors, glove compartment, footwell and  
luggage compartment lights are also  
provided.  
When the vehicle is unlocked the courtesy  
lights will come on at maximum  
brightness for approximately 30 seconds  
if a door is not opened.  
With the engine running, opening any  
door will put on all interior lights, they will  
go out immediately after the last door is  
closed.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Glove compartment  
The glove compartment will illuminate  
when opened.  
DIRECTION INDICATORS  
Luggage compartment lighting  
The luggage compartment will be  
illuminated when the lid is opened.  
Battery saver  
If the interior lights are switched on using  
the centre switch in the overhead console  
and the ignition switch is in convenience  
mode, the lights will automatically turn  
OFF after approximately 15 minutes after  
returning from convenience mode to  
power off.  
JAG0139G  
The direction indicators operate when the  
ignition system is ON.  
The left column stalk has two positions for  
indicating left or right turn.  
If the interior lights are switched on by  
opening a door, the lights will  
automatically turn off after approximately  
15 minutes after returning from  
The first position, moving the stalk up or  
down, causes the indicator to flash while  
it is held in this position.  
convenience mode to power off.  
Flicking the stalk will give a three flash  
lane changing signal.  
If the glove compartment lights, luggage  
compartment lights, reading and  
map lights or vanity lights are switched  
on, and the ignition switch is in  
convenience mode or the remote  
handset is removed, the lights will  
automatically turn OFF after  
The second position is a full movement of  
the stalk up or down to indicate for a right  
or left turn, which can then be released.  
The indicators will remain flashing and will  
cancel when the turn is completed.  
approximately 15 minutes after returning  
from convenience mode to power off.  
An audible ticking and a flashing green  
arrow on the instrument cluster indicates  
that the selected direction indicator is ON.  
Note: Should a direction indicator bulb  
fail, the corresponding side green warning  
light will flash at twice the normal rate. The  
audible ticking will sound at twice the  
normal rate.  
Lane change flash  
Move the left column stalk partially up or  
down against spring pressure, then  
release, to indicate a lane change. The  
relevant direction indicator flashes three  
times.  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
If the stalk is held against spring pressure,  
the direction indicators will continue to  
operate until the stalk is released.  
REAR FOG LAMP  
The rear fog lamp can only be switched  
on if the low beam headlamps are on or if  
the sidelamps and front fog lamps are  
switched on.  
Lane change flash can be disabled or  
enabled by a Jaguar Dealer.  
Press the switch 2 to turn on the rear fog  
lamp. Pushing the switch again will turn  
off the rear fog lamp.  
FRONT FOG LAMPS  
The fog lamps can only be switched on  
when the ignition system is ON and when  
sidelamp or low beam is selected.  
Note:  
Both front and rear fog lamps will be  
turned off when the ignition system is  
turned off, but will not be illuminated  
when the ignition system is turned on  
again.  
1
The rear fog lamp should only be used  
when visibility is severely restricted by  
fog.  
2
JAG0140L  
With the lighting control switch in  
sidelamp or low beam position, press the  
switch 1 to turn on the front fog lamps.  
Pushing the switch again will turn off the  
front fog lamps.  
Note: The front fog lamps should only be  
used when visibility is severely restricted  
by fog.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS  
ADJUSTING THE HEADLAMPS  
When touring in right-hand traffic  
countries, use the beam adjustment  
mechanism located within each  
headlamp unit to alter the beam pattern  
accordingly.  
JAG0142G  
The switch is in the centre console below  
the touch-screen and operates with the  
ignition ON or OFF. Use only in an  
emergency to warn traffic of a vehicle  
breakdown or approaching danger.  
To operate: Press the switch; the  
direction indicators, the instrument  
cluster green indicators and audible  
warning will operate in unison. The switch  
icon will flash in unison with the  
indicators.  
JAG0144G  
When this is moved it enables the vehicle  
to be driven in opposite hand drive  
markets without having to stick blanking  
decals onto the headlamp lens.  
To cancel: Press the switch again.  
HEADLAMP LEVELLING  
Auto headlight levelling  
Automatic levelling of the headlamps is a  
feature which avoids dazzling oncoming  
drivers. A control unit adjusts the aim of  
the lamps during acceleration,  
To adjust the headlamp:  
1. Remove the headlamp unit, see page  
78.  
2. Twist anticlockwise and lift off the rear  
headlamp unit cover.  
3. Locate the adjustment lever, as  
shown.  
deceleration and vehicle load conditions.  
4. Move the lever fully downwards.  
5. Refit the high beam cover and the  
headlamp unit, see page 79.  
Remember to place the levers back in  
their original position when you have  
returned to your country of origin.  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
CHANGING A BULB  
It is important that only the Jaguar  
1
2
3
4
5
specified bulbs are used when renewing  
bulbs.  
The message centre will display a  
message indicating which bulb requires  
to be replaced.  
Before renewing bulbs, switch off the  
ignition system and light switches.  
To change the bulbs within the headlamp  
and taillamp, the complete units require to  
be removed from the vehicle.  
JAG0145G  
Note: In most countries it is illegal to use  
a vehicle with a defective exterior lamp  
bulb.  
1. Side marker (bulb type WY5W).  
2. Direction indicator (bulb type, front  
Headlight unit  
3457AK, rear PY21Silver Vision).  
3. Low and high beam projector unit  
(bulb type D1S35W).  
!
WARNING:  
4. Sidelamp (bulb type W5W).  
Replacement or maintenance of  
Xenon lights should be carried out  
only by a Jaguar Dealer.  
5. Cornering lamp (bulb type H8).  
Used Xenon lamp units contain  
mercury which is hazardous and  
can be injurious to health.  
Bi-Xenon lamp units operate at a  
high temperature. If they have  
recently been in use, allow  
sufficient time for them to cool  
down before touching them.  
The Xenon system generates up to  
28,000 volts and contact with this  
voltage could lead to a fatality.  
Ensure that headlamps are  
switched off before working on the  
system.  
Caution: Seek advice about proper  
disposal of Bi-Xenon lamp units from  
your Jaguar Dealer or your local  
authority.  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Removal of the headlamp unit  
5
3
4
2
1
2
JAG0146G  
1. Remove the lower headlamp securing  
bolt 1 located in the front of the wheel  
arch. Turn the steering wheel to the  
left, when removing the right-hand  
headlamp and to the right when  
4. Release the headlamp locating peg by  
lifting the tongue upwards 4.  
5. Carefully ease the headlamp unit  
forward to gain access to the wiring  
multi-plug connector. Release the  
connector by pressing upwards on  
the release button and pull the wiring  
multi-plug from the headlamp 5. Place  
the headlamp unit on a flat surface  
covered in a soft material to prevent  
damage to the unit’s lens.  
removing the left-hand headlamp.  
2. Open the hood and remove the upper  
securing bolts 2.  
3. Disconnect the headlamp powerwash  
connector by pressing the button and  
pulling the pipe apart 3, some washer  
fluid may drain from the pipe when it  
is disconnected.  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Refitting the headlamp unit  
Front side marker lamp  
3
2
3
JAG0148G  
1. Remove the headlamp unit, see page  
78.  
2. Twist the bulb holder counter  
clockwise and pull out the bulb  
complete with the bulb holder.  
JAG0147G  
1. Reconnect the wiring multi-plug  
3. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder.  
connector.  
4. Insert the new bulb (WY5W) and  
repeat the above procedure in reverse  
order.  
2. Offer up the unit into position.  
3. Ensure that the locating peg is fitted  
into the in-board locating hole.  
4. To secure the headlamp unit, first  
secure the wheel arch screw, then  
repeat the removal procedure in the  
reverse order, ensuring that the  
powerwash pipe is reconnected.  
Note: After the replacement of any bulb  
and the fitting of the headlamp unit, the  
aim of the headlamps should be checked  
by a Jaguar Dealer.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Front direction indicator lamp  
Front sidelamp  
2
2
3
4
JAG0122N  
1. Remove the headlamp unit, see page  
JAG0150G  
78.  
2. Twist the bulb holder counter  
clockwise and pull out the bulb  
complete with the electrical  
connector.  
1. Remove the headlamp unit, see page  
78.  
2. Twist and lift off the side domed cap.  
3. Pull out the bulb complete with bulb  
3. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder.  
holder.  
4. Insert the new bulb (3457AK) and  
repeat the above procedure in reverse  
order.  
4. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder.  
5. Insert the new bulb (W5W) and repeat  
the above procedure in the reverse  
order. Ensure that the cover is fitted  
correctly to retain the water tightness.  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Dip and main beam projector unit  
5. Press the bulb unit adaptor ring catch  
and remove the adaptor ring from the  
bulb unit.  
Caution: It is strongly advised that the  
High Intensity Discharge (HID) Xenon  
low and high beam projector unit  
(D1S35W) is replaced by a Jaguar  
Dealer.  
6. Secure the bulb unit adaptor ring onto  
the new bulb (D1S35W) and repeat  
the above procedure in the reverse  
order. Ensure that the cover is fitted  
correctly to retain the water tightness.  
2
3
5
4
JAG0151G  
1. Remove the headlamp unit, see page  
78.  
2. Twist and lift off the rear domed cap.  
3. Twist the bulb unit counter clockwise  
to unlock it. Pull the bulb unit clear of  
the headlamp unit.  
4. Press the electrical connector release  
lever and disconnect the bulb unit.  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Cornering or static bending lamp  
3. Twist the bulb holder counter  
clockwise to unlock, then pull out the  
bulb complete with electrical  
connector.  
Caution: Halogen bulbs will be  
damaged if touched by hand or  
contaminated with oil or grease. It is  
important to use clean gloves or lint  
free cloth when handling a bulb which  
is to be used again. A contaminated  
bulb may be cleaned with methylated  
spirit before refitting.  
4. To release the bulb unit, lift the two  
catches of the electrical connector,  
then pull to remove the bulb unit.  
5. Insert the new bulb unit (H8) and  
repeat the above procedure in the  
reverse order. Ensure that the cover is  
fitted correctly to retain the water  
tightness.  
Front fog lamp  
It is recommended that the front fog lamp  
bulb is renewed by a Jaguar Dealer.  
2
Rear fog and reverse lamps  
!
WARNING:  
LED lamp units operate at a high  
temperature. If they have recently been  
in use, allow sufficient time for them to  
cool down before touching them.  
3
These lamps are LED units and are  
integral to the luggage compartment lid.  
They should only be replaced by a Jaguar  
Dealer.  
4
JAG0152G  
1. Remove the headlamp unit, see page  
78.  
2. Twist and lift off the side domed cap.  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
License plate lamp  
Side repeater indicator  
1
1
3
JAG0154G  
3
1. Push the lens firmly towards the rear  
of the vehicle and withdraw the light  
unit from the wing panel.  
2. Twist to release the bulb holder from  
JAG0153G  
the lens unit.  
1. Insert a wide flat bladed suitable tool,  
twist and lever the lens out of the  
surround panel. Ensure that the lens  
moves to the outer edge of the  
surround panel to release the  
securing tangs.  
3. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder.  
4. Insert the new bulb (WY5W) and  
repeat the above procedure in the  
reverse order.  
2. Twist and pull out the bulb holder  
complete with bulb.  
3. Pull the bulb out of the bulb holder.  
4. Insert the new bulb (W5WL).  
5. Refit the lens by locating the outboard  
securing tangs first and then pressing  
it firmly into the recess until it clicks.  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Removal of the rear lamp unit  
2
1
3
JAG0155G  
The rear lamp unit contains four lamp  
bulbs and it is necessary to remove the  
unit from the vehicle in order to change  
any of the bulbs.  
3. Firmly pull the rear lamp unit away  
from the vehicle and disconnect the  
wiring multi-plug connector. Remove  
the lamp unit from the vehicle and  
place the unit on a flat surface  
covered in a soft material to prevent  
damage to the unit’s lens. Each bulb  
is now accessible by twisting off its  
bulb holder and removing the bulb,  
see page 85.  
1. Open the luggage compartment. For  
the right-hand side unit, detach the  
interior light unit from the trim panel  
(Convertible) or the vent trim panel  
(Coupe) and remove the two rear lamp  
unit securing nuts. For the left-hand  
side unit, detach the vent trim panel  
and remove the rear lamp unit  
4. Insert a new bulb and repeat the  
above procedure in the reverse order.  
securing nut.  
2. Firmly pull the rear lamp unit trim  
panel from the vehicle.  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting  
Rear lamp unit replacement bulbs  
1
2
3
4
JAG0156G  
1. Side marker, (W5W).  
2. Direction indicator, (PY21W Silver  
Vision).  
3. Stop and Tail, (P21/5W).  
4. Tail, (W5W).  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows and Mirrors  
Windows and Mirrors  
These switches will only operate the  
windows for five minutes when the  
ignition switch remains in the  
convenience mode position and the  
driver’s and passenger’s doors remain  
closed.  
ELECTRIC WINDOWS  
Raise and lower  
To lower a window, press and hold the  
front of the switch until the desired  
position is reached, then release.  
To raise a window, pull up and hold the  
front of the switch until the desired  
position is reached, then release.  
JAG0160L  
If the switches are held for longer than six  
seconds, for example, when attempting  
to overcome frozen or jammed windows,  
the window drive will be switched off for a  
few seconds to protect the window drive  
motors.  
!
WARNING:  
Before operating power windows  
you should verify they are free of  
obstructions and ensure that  
children and or pets are not in the  
proximity of window openings.  
Failure to do so could result in  
serious personal injury. It is the  
primary responsibility of the  
One-touch operation  
Each window has a one-touch facility  
enabling the occupant to fully open or  
close the window in one quick movement.  
supervising adults to never leave a  
child unattended in a vehicle.  
Press the switch briefly to close or open  
the window in one movement. Window  
travel can be stopped at any time by  
pressing the switch again, but will then be  
controlled by pressing and holding the  
switch.  
When raising windows ensure all  
occupants are clear.  
When leaving the vehicle take the  
ignition keys to prevent misuse of  
the window switches by remaining  
occupants, especially children.  
Automatic window drop for door  
opening  
Switches on the driver’s door controls  
both the driver and passenger door  
windows.  
The frameless door windows create a seal  
against the convertible top or the roof  
seals. If fully raised, the door windows will  
drop partially when the door release lever  
is operated, this is to allow easy door  
opening. When the door is closed the  
windows rise to the fully closed position.  
The passenger door is provided with a  
switch to control that door window only.  
The ignition system must to be ON to  
operate the windows.  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows and Mirrors  
The doors must not be opened if power  
for automatic window drop is not  
available, e.g. with battery disconnected.  
However, in an emergency the doors can  
be opened with the windows fully up.  
Typically this might be due to icing in  
winter but could also be caused by  
damage or misalignment of the guide  
channels or seals.  
After the initial attempt to close the  
window and the anti-trap detection  
has initiated, operate the close switch  
a second time. This action must be  
carried out within ten seconds.  
Window anti-trap protection  
!
WARNING:  
Careless closing of the windows  
can override the protection  
function and cause injuries.  
The window will attempt to close  
again and operate the anti-trap  
detection. The window will now close  
again for the third time, but will only  
operate by pressing and holding the  
switch with the anti-trap detection  
disabled. The window will now close  
with full power. The icing in the seal  
can now be broken and dispersed.  
If the battery is disconnected or  
discharged the window anti-trap  
protection feature is lost. When the  
battery is reconnected or  
recharged the window anti-trap  
protection system must be reset.  
Repeat the override action until the  
window has closed. Each time the  
window stops, the switch must be  
operated immediately to initiate  
further override action.  
Each electrically operated window has a  
anti-trap protection feature. If the upward  
movement of the window detects an  
obstacle the anti-trap detection system  
will immediately stop the window closing,  
then move it downwards for a short  
distance.  
If this procedure fails to move the  
blockage, the anti-trap detection feature  
will be lost and must be reset after the  
blockage has been cleared.  
Anti-trap protection override  
Reset window anti-trap protection  
Ensure that the respective door is closed  
and, if fitted, the convertible roof closed.  
!
WARNING:  
While the window is being closed for  
the third time, the anti-trap detection  
function is disabled. Make sure there  
are no obstacles in the way of the  
closing window.  
Fully close the window, then release  
the switch. Again pull the switch to  
close the window and hold for two  
seconds.  
The anti-trap protection will also stop the  
window closing if a blockage or  
resistance occurs e.g. in the window  
guide channels.  
Open the window fully and release the  
switch. Again press the switch to  
open the window and hold for two  
seconds.  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows and Mirrors  
Check to confirm the operation by  
opening the window and then use one  
touch operation to close the window.  
To lower: Press the rear of the switch for  
less than a second and the rear quarter  
windows will be driven down fully.  
Repeat for the remaining electrically  
operated windows.  
To raise: Press the front of the switch and  
hold and the rear quarter windows will  
rise for as long as the switch is held.  
Thermal overload  
Notes on rear quarter window  
operation:  
If the windows are repeatedly opened and  
closed (e.g. by a child), a protection  
system will de-activate window operation  
for a short period to avoid overheating of  
the window motors.  
1. When the convertible roof is opened  
the rear quarter windows are  
automatically lowered and cannot be  
operated until the roof is closed.  
When the roof is closed the rear  
quarter windows are automatically  
raised.  
Caution: Do not close the door with the  
windows fully up as damage to the  
seals and the glass will occur.  
Rear quarter window operation  
(Convertible only)  
2. The rear quarter windows operate  
together and cannot be operated  
individually.  
The rear quarter windows operate  
automatically in conjunction with  
convertible roof opening or closing.  
WINDOW TINTING  
Caution: Do not have your vehicle  
windows tinted with a metal oxide  
tinting (for maximum heat reduction  
from the sun) if you have a telephone or  
navigation system fitted to your  
vehicle.  
Metal oxide tinting prevents the reception  
of the Global Positioning System (GPS)  
signals by the antenna, causing the  
navigation system to stop functioning.  
A nonmetal tinting should be used if you  
require window tinting and if in doubt,  
contact your Jaguar Dealer for advice.  
JAG0162L  
The rear quarter windows may also be  
operated independently of the convertible  
roof when the convertible roof is closed,  
by means of the convertible roof switch  
on the overhead console, as follows:  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows and Mirrors  
Mirror heating  
ELECTRIC EXTERIOR  
Caution: Do not use a scraper to  
remove ice from the mirrors as this will  
damage the surface.  
MIRRORS  
Caution: The right-hand mirror is  
convex, providing a wider field of  
vision. As a result, objects viewed in  
the mirror are closer than they appear.  
The door mirrors have heating elements  
which operate automatically based on the  
external ambient temperature of the  
vehicle. The mirror heater will clear all ice  
from the mirror surface.  
2
1
Mirror dip when reversing  
Reverse mirror dipping is selected via the  
touch-screen.  
From the main Home touch-screen  
menu, select Vehicle:  
Select Veh. settings.  
2
JAG0041L  
The Security button is selected  
automatically as the default.  
Both electrochromic door mirrors are  
adjusted from the driver’s door  
switchpack.  
Vehicle  
Reverse  
On  
Security  
Off  
The four-way adjustment button 1 moves  
the mirrors to the required position. The  
selector button 2 selects the mirror to be  
moved, L for the left-hand side mirror and  
R for the right-hand side mirror.  
mirror dip  
Parking  
Valet mode  
Vol. presets  
The mirror housings are designed to pivot  
against the vehicle upon impact.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0165NAS  
Caution: If door mirrors have been  
folded against the vehicle due to an  
impact, reposition the mirrors  
manually.  
Select Parking.  
Select Reverse mirror dip ON.  
When reverse gear is selected, the  
passenger mirror inclines downwards to  
provide a close up view of the rear side  
area. When the gear selector is moved out  
of reverse, the mirror will return to its  
original position.  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows and Mirrors  
The reverse mirror dip alignment can be  
The automatic darkening of the mirror  
adjusted by using the four-way  
will not operate properly if the light  
that would otherwise strike the mirror  
is obstructed.  
adjustment button 1 when the mirror has  
completed movement to its reverse dip  
position. This new selected position is  
maintained until re-adjusted  
Note: When reversing, if a speed of  
greater than 7 km/h (4 mph) is achieved,  
then the mirrors will revert to the previous  
position. However, if the speed is then  
reduced to below 7 km/h (4 mph), then the  
mirrors will revert to the dipped position.  
INTERIOR MIRROR  
JAG0168L  
During night time driving with the ignition  
switched on, the interior mirror will darken  
automatically in proportion to the amount  
of glare detected from a following  
vehicle’s headlights.  
When you shift the gear selector lever into  
reverse, the interior mirror dimming  
feature will be automatically switched off  
for a clearer view whilst reversing.  
Note:  
Should a mirror assembly become  
detached from the windshield, it must  
be refitted by a Jaguar Dealer.  
Ensure that the windshield in front of  
the mirror is kept clean. Where fitted,  
the moisture sensor for wiper  
operation is located to the front of the  
mirror casing. Any dirt may affect the  
operation of this sensor.  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
Chapter  
4
for which they have been designed.  
A slack belt will greatly reduce the  
protection afforded to the wearer.  
FASTENING THE SEAT BELTS  
!
WARNING:  
Seat belts are life saving  
Care should be taken to avoid  
contamination of the webbing with  
polishes, oils and chemicals, and  
particularly battery acid. Cleaning  
may safely be carried out using  
mild soap and water.The belt  
should be replaced if webbing  
becomes frayed, contaminated or  
damaged.  
equipment. In a collision,  
occupants not wearing a seat belt  
can be thrown around inside, or  
possibly thrown out of the vehicle.  
This is likely to result in more  
serious injuries than would have  
been the case had a seat belt been  
properly worn. It may even result in  
loss of life.  
It is essential to replace the entire  
assembly after it has been worn in a  
severe impact even if damage to  
the assembly is not obvious.  
Make sure all occupants are  
securely strapped in at all times -  
even for the shortest journeys.  
No modifications or additions  
should be made by the user which  
will either prevent the seat belt  
adjusting devices from operating  
to remove slack, or prevent the  
seat belt assembly from being  
adjusted to remove slack.  
Belts should not be worn with the  
straps twisted.  
Always ensure that the webbing is  
midway between the neck and the  
edge of the shoulder.  
Each seat belt assembly must only  
be used by one occupant; it is  
dangerous to put a belt around a  
child being carried on the  
occupant’s lap.  
Should the seat belt not retract and  
remain at its static length, you  
should consult your nearest Jaguar  
Dealer immediately.  
Do not try to put an adult seat belt  
around two children.  
Replacement and renewal of seat  
belts should be carried out by  
Jaguar Dealers only.  
Seat belts are designed to bear  
upon the bony structure of the body  
and should be worn low across the  
front of the pelvis or the pelvis,  
chest and shoulders, as applicable;  
wearing the lap section of the belt  
across the abdominal area must be  
avoided.  
The use of front and rear seat belts is  
mandatory in most countries. Using seat  
belts saves lives.  
Seat belts should be adjusted as  
firmly as possible, consistent with  
comfort, to provide the protection  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
Note: If the vehicle is parked on unlevel  
ground, the seat belt mechanism may  
lock. This is not a fault, allow the seat belt  
to retract a small amount before gently  
easing the belt from its attachment to  
unlock it.  
1
2
Belt buckle release  
To release the belt buckle, press the  
release button 2 in the buckle unit and  
guide the belt back up to the seat  
mounted webbing guide.  
JAG0173G  
Front occupants only: The front seat  
belts are equipped with an automatic  
webbing tension relieving device. This  
device will reduce the webbing loads  
experienced by the occupant when the  
seat belt is correctly worn without  
inducing any slack webbing.  
!
WARNING:  
Do not adjust the seat belt while  
driving.  
Draw the tongue of the seat belt over the  
shoulder, across the chest and push it  
into the buckle unit slot 1. A positive click  
indicates that it is safely locked.  
The device is activated when, with the  
ignition system ON and the seat belt  
tongue engaged in the buckle, webbing is  
extracted on occupant lean forward (a  
series of clicks indicate the range of  
movement with reduced tension).  
The use of comfort clips or devices that  
would create slackness in the seat belt  
system is not advised.  
Ensure that the webbing is midway  
between the neck and the edge of the  
shoulder. Correct tension is controlled by  
automatic retraction of the reel.  
If the engine is turned off with the seat  
belts still fastened, a slight increase in  
seat belt tension may be felt. This is  
normal, it is part of the seat belt  
Always wear seat belts without slack or  
twists, since any slack in a seat belt  
reduces the effectiveness of the belt and  
the level of protection it can provide. For  
optimum protection, the seat belts should  
fit tightly around the body. Do not recline  
the front seats excessively. Optimum  
benefit is obtained from the seat belt with  
the seat back angle set to no more than  
30 degrees from the upright.  
assembly’s tension control device.  
Front passenger seat belt -belt  
tensioner sensor (Canada and USA  
only)  
The front passenger seat belt is fitted with  
a belt tension sensor which is part of the  
occupant classification sensor system,  
for further information see page 96.  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
Seat belt guide and retainer  
Inertia reel mechanism test  
With the seat belt fastened, give the  
webbing near the buckle a quick  
upward pull. The buckle must remain  
securely locked.  
With the seat belt unfastened, unreel  
the webbing to the limit of its travel.  
Check that the unreeling is free from  
snatches and snags and then allow  
the belt to fully retract.  
Partially unreel the webbing, then  
hold the tongue plate and give it a  
quick forward pull. The mechanism  
must lock automatically and prevent  
any further unreeling.  
JAG0174L  
To assist with both access and  
positioning of the front seat belt webbing,  
a guide-retainer is incorporated into each  
front seat.  
If a seat belt should fail any of these  
tests, contact your Jaguar Dealer.  
When the front seat back is tilted forward  
to gain access to the rear of the vehicle it  
is recommended that the seat belt is  
removed from the guide.  
SEAT BELT REMINDER  
The belt reminder feature provides  
additional reminder to the driver that an  
occupant’s seat belt is unbuckled. A  
chime will sound intermittently.  
On returning the front seat back to the  
upright position ensure that the seat belt  
is returned to the seat belt guide.  
Note: Not all countries have the warning  
chime.  
Seat belt warning  
A warning indicator on the  
instrument panel is illuminated  
when:  
The driver’s seat belt is not fastened.  
A passenger is sitting in the front seat  
and their seat belt is not fastened.  
In some countries a warning signal  
sounds for six seconds.  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
USING SEAT BELTS DURING  
PREGNANCY  
JAG0176G  
!
WARNING:  
Position the seat belt correctly for the  
mother and unborn child. Never wear  
just the lap strap and never sit on the  
lap strap while using just the shoulder  
strap. Both of these actions are  
extremely dangerousand mayincrease  
your risk of serious injury in the event  
of an accident.  
Position the lap strap comfortably across  
the hips and low beneath the pregnant  
abdomen. Place the diagonal part of the  
seat belt between the breasts, above and  
to the side of the pregnant abdomen.  
Always wear a seat belt without slack or  
twists.  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
If an air bag has inflated, the air bag  
OCCUPANT SENSING  
will not function again and must be  
renewed immediately. If a new air  
bag is not fitted, the unrepaired  
area will increase the risk of injury  
in a collision.  
!
WARNING:  
No objects whatsoever should be  
attached to the centre cover of the  
steering wheel, the passenger  
fascia panel, the sides of the front  
seats or the interior trim  
In order to provide optimum protection  
this vehicle is equipped with front and  
side air bags. They are used in  
immediately above the door  
openings. Do not put anything on or  
over the air bag inflation area.  
Placing objects on or over the air  
bag inflation area may cause those  
objects to be propelled inside the  
vehicle causing serious injury to the  
occupants.  
conjunction with the seat belts to help  
protect occupants from upper body  
(thorax) and head injuries.  
Occupants with disabilities that  
may require the vehicle to be  
modified must contact a Jaguar  
Dealer before any modifications are  
made.  
Note: (USA only) If you are considering  
modifying your vehicle in any way to  
accommodate a disability, for  
example by altering or adapting the  
driver’s or passenger’s seat(s) or air  
bag system, please contact Jaguar  
Cars at:  
Jaguar Cars  
Customer Relations Center  
555 MacArthur Blvd  
Mahwah  
New Jersey 07430-2327  
1-800-4JAGUAR OPTIONS 9.  
Several air bag system components  
get hot after inflation. Do not touch  
them after they have deployed.  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
1
2
3
JAG0177L  
Air bag location  
Occupancy classification sensor  
1. Driver’s air bag.  
2. Front passenger air bag.  
3. Combined head and thorax side air  
bags are identified by labels.  
System sensors  
The air bags and seat belt pretensioners  
are electrically controlled by an Advanced  
Restraints Technology System (ARTS).  
Various sensors determine the direction  
and severity of an impact. The system  
analyses this information then deploys  
only the appropriate air bags e.g. the side  
air bags where the impact is on that side  
only.  
JAG0512L  
A weight sensitive sensor is located in the  
front passenger seat to determine the  
weight acting upon the seat. In certain  
conditions, e.g. where no passenger is  
present, the appropriate will be  
are not designed to deploy at very low  
speeds or in rear impacts.  
deactivated. In a collision these would not  
be deployed.  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
The occupancy weight sensor operates  
If the seat is occupied by a larger child  
as follows:  
or adult, the front passenger air bag  
will be activated and the air bag  
indicator will not be illuminated.  
Passenger Passenger  
occupancy air bag  
status  
Indicator  
active  
** (Canada and USA only) Belt  
tension sensor (BTS): If a child  
restraint is fitted in the front  
status  
Completely Deactivated No*  
passenger seat using the seat belt’s  
automatic locking device (see page  
105), then the BTS supports the  
decision function of the occupant  
classification sensor and the front  
passenger air bag is deactivated.  
empty  
Low weight Deactivated Yes  
occupant/  
object  
Heavy  
occupant/  
object  
Child  
restraint  
fitted **  
Activated  
No  
Note: The occupancy sensing system is  
designed to confirm that a front  
passenger is properly seated as  
recommended:  
Deactivated Yes  
Always sit centrally in the seat,  
remaining in contact with the seat  
back which for comfort should be  
rearwards of the vertical position.  
*It is possible to receive an intermittent  
indicator illuminated with an empty seat  
condition. This is part of the system’s  
adaptive behaviour, and does not affect  
the status of the passenger air bag.  
However, if the indicator becomes  
permanently illuminated when the seat is  
definitely empty and the seat belt is  
unbuckled, then contact your nearest  
Jaguar Dealer immediately.  
Adjust the seat to be as far back from  
the facia as is practical.  
Always wear seat belts.  
The seat adjustment controls are  
described on page 57.  
If the seat is empty and the seat belt  
unbuckled, the front passenger air  
bag will not be activated and the air  
bag indicator will not be illuminated.  
If the seat is occupied by, for  
example, a small child or object with  
the seat belt buckled, the front  
passenger air bag will not be  
activated and the air bag indicator will  
be illuminated.  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
Air bag deactivation indicator  
7. Passenger side crash sensor.  
8. Right-hand rollover protection bar  
(convertible only).  
9. Left-hand rollover protection bar  
(convertible only).  
10. Restraint control module.  
11. Driver side crash sensor.  
12. Driver side head and thorax air bag.  
13. Driver buckle pretensioner.  
14. Driver dual stage air bag (steering  
JAG0516N  
wheel).  
The air bag indicator, on the centre  
console is associated with the  
deployment conditions for front seat  
passenger air bags only.  
1
Whenever the air bag indicator is  
illuminated, the front passenger air bags  
will not be deployed in the event of an  
impact. Where the air bags are not  
deployed, protection is provided by the  
seat belts.  
2
Note: The air bag indicator will illuminate  
when the ignition system initially comes  
on as part of the warning lamp check and  
will extinguish after approximately six  
seconds.  
14  
3
4
5
13  
12  
6
11  
10  
7
Overall system components  
The overall occupant protection system,  
Advanced Restraint Technology System  
(ARTS) comprises the following  
components:  
9
8
JAG0538N  
1. Dual front crash sensors.  
2. Passenger dual stage air bag.  
3. Passenger buckle pretensioner.  
4. Passenger seat occupancy sensor.  
5. Passenger belt tension sensor.  
6. Passenger side head and thorax air  
bag.  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
- See Owners Manual for more  
information about air bags.  
AIR BAG LABELS  
DRIVER AIR BAG  
!
WARNING:  
The air bag is a supplementary  
restraint system that provides  
additional protection in a severe  
impact only - it does not replace the  
need to wear seat belts. For maximum  
safety protection in all crash situations,  
a seat belt must be worn.  
Note: Provided front seat occupants are  
correctly seated, with seat belts worn, the  
air bag will give additional protection to  
the chest and facial areas in the event of  
an accident.  
Both front air bags use a dual inflation  
technology which means, if activated, the  
air bags will deploy as appropriate for the  
severity of frontal impact.  
JAG0540N  
An alert label on the front face of the  
driver’s and passenger’s sun visor directs  
you to read the warning label on the rear  
face of each sun visor.  
Air bag deployment  
!
WARNING:  
Activation of an air bag creates dust,  
causing possible breathing difficulties  
for asthma sufferers or other people  
with respiratory problems. If an air bag  
is activated, any occupant who suffers  
from breathing difficulties should;  
either leave the vehicle as quickly as  
possible, or obtain fresh air by fully  
opening the windows and doors.  
The warning label contains the following  
statement:  
!
WARNING:  
EVEN WITH ADVANCED AIR BAGS  
- Children can be killed or seriously  
injured by the air bag.  
- The back seat is the safest place for  
children.  
Following inflation, some air bag  
components are hot - do not touch  
until they have cooled.  
- Never put a rear-facing child seat in  
the front.  
- Always use seat belts and child  
restraints.  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
Even with air bag equipment fitted,  
Front protection  
seat belts must always be worn  
because:  
An air bag will only provide  
additional protection in certain  
types of frontal collision. No  
protection is afforded against the  
effects of rear impacts, or minor  
frontal impacts.  
Inflation and deflation takes place  
instantaneously and will not  
provide protection against the  
effects of secondary impacts that  
can occur during multiple vehicle  
collisions.  
JAG0183L  
With a front impact of sufficient force,  
the restraints system will trigger the front  
air bag(s) and seat belt pretensioners,  
which immediately tighten the seat belts.  
An inflating air bag can cause facial  
abrasions and other injuries.  
Minimise the risk of injury by  
ensuring that front seat occupants  
are wearing their seat belts and are  
seated correctly, with the seat as  
far back as is practical.  
The seat belts then ease, allowing the  
head and chest to contact the inflated air  
bag.The air bag absorbs the remaining  
energy of the impact and then deflates  
rapidly via vent holes.  
When an air bag inflates, a fine powder is  
released. This is not an indication of a  
malfunction. However, the powder may  
cause irritation to the skin and should be  
thoroughly flushed from the eyes and any  
cuts or abrasions of the skin. After  
inflation, front and side air bags deflate  
immediately (head air bags deflate  
slowly). This provides a gradual  
Front air bags are designed to inflate only  
in frontal and near frontal collisions.  
cushioning effect for the occupants and  
also ensures that the driver’s forward  
vision is not obscured.  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
SIDE AIR BAGS  
AIR BAG WARNING LAMP  
The air bag warning indicator in  
the driver’s instrument panel  
will be lit for approximately six  
seconds when the ignition is turned on.  
If the indicator remains on, it indicates a  
fault. Report the fault to a Jaguar Dealer  
immediately. It is safe to drive the vehicle;  
however, in an accident the air bags may  
not operate.  
Air bag warning lamp information is  
shown on page 115.  
AIR BAG SERVICE  
INFORMATION  
JAG0185L  
Air bag disposal  
!
WARNING:  
To ensure that the side air bags are  
fully effective do not sit too close to, or  
lean against the door trim. The side air  
bag could injure you as it deploys from  
the side of the seat.  
!
WARNING:  
Do not attempt to service, repair,  
replace, modify or tamper with any part  
of the air bag system or its electrical  
fuses. Doing so could cause the  
system to activate, resulting in  
personal injury.  
The air bags, in combination with the seat  
belts, can help reduce the risk of severe  
injuries in the event of a significant side  
impact collision.  
In the event of the vehicle being  
dismantled, air bag module removal and  
disposal must be carried out by a  
qualified person.  
When the seat mounted head and thorax  
air bag inflates, it breaks through the seat  
bolster stitching, giving protection to the  
side of the rib cage and head of the driver  
or front seat passenger.  
The combined head and thorax side air  
bags are designed to inflate only in a side  
impact collision, unless the collision  
causes sufficient lateral deceleration.  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Protection  
Do not try to reset the system if it  
deploys.  
WHIPLASH PROTECTION  
Do not let anyone sit on the top  
cover.  
The Rollover Protection Device (RPD)  
consists of two inverted U-shaped bars,  
that are concealed underneath the rear  
parcel shelf behind the rear passenger  
seats, and sensors that monitor the  
attitude of the vehicle.  
JAG0528L  
Both front seats are equipped with Active  
Head Restraints (AHR) which reduce the  
risk of neck and spinal injury (whiplash) in  
the event of a rear impact.  
JAG0189G  
When activated, the head restraint moves  
upwards and forwards, supporting the  
occupant’s head.  
If the sensors determine that a risk of  
rollover is imminent, the rollover bars will  
be deployed.  
After activation, the whiplash protection  
mechanism automatically resets and  
does not require to be replaced.  
Note: When the rollover bars are  
deployed they will deliberately break the  
rear screen if the convertible top is closed.  
If the Rollover Protection Device has been  
deployed, proceed to your nearest Jaguar  
Dealer to check for any damage and to  
reset the system.  
ROLLOVER BARS  
(Convertible only)  
!
WARNING:  
Do not place any objects on top of  
the system trim covers behind the  
rear passenger head restraints as  
they could prevent correct  
deployment of the system.  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Safety  
Child Safety  
Do not install a rearward-facing  
CHILD SEATS  
child seat in the front passenger  
seat position since deployment of  
the passenger facia air bag could  
cause death or serious injury to the  
child.  
General safety information  
If, however, you have no alternative  
but to place a child in the front  
passenger seat, use only a  
forward-facing child seat with the  
passenger seat set fully rearward  
and in its lowest position.  
Always follow the fitting  
instructions supplied with the  
appropriate child restraint system.  
It is important to read and  
understand all the information  
contained in this handbook relating  
to child safety before carrying a  
child in your vehicle.  
If you are unsure about any aspect  
of this information, contact your  
Jaguar Dealer.  
JAG0190L  
In many countries legislation governs how  
and where children should be carried  
when travelling in a vehicle.  
!
WARNING:  
It is the responsibility of the driver to  
comply with all regulations in force in the  
country where the vehicle is being used.  
Extreme hazard! Do not use a  
rearward facing child restraint on a  
seat protected by an air bag in front  
of it!  
Holding a baby or child in a person’s arms  
is not a substitute for a child restraint  
system.  
Children must be restrained by a  
child safety restraint that is suitable  
for their weight and size.  
In an accident, a baby or child held in this  
manner can be crushed between the  
vehicle’s interior and a restrained person.  
Children 12 years old and younger  
can be killed or seriously injured by  
the air bag. The rear seat is the  
safest place for properly restrained  
children.  
The child can be injured by hitting the  
interior or by being thrown from the  
vehicle during a sudden manoeuvre or  
impact.  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Safety  
The seat belts fitted to your vehicle are  
Always check that the child seat can be  
mounted securely in the required  
position: if in doubt, you should speak to  
your Jaguar Dealer.  
designed for adults and larger children.  
For their safety, it is very important that all  
infants and children under 12 years of age  
are restrained in a suitable child safety  
seat appropriate to their age and size..  
Look for the following when selecting a  
child restraint system:  
Choosing a suitable child seat  
It should have a label certifying that it  
meets the applicable Regulations.  
Carefully read the instructions  
supplied with the restraint. Be sure  
you understand them and can install  
and use the device properly and  
safely in the vehicle.  
!
WARNING:  
Choose a child seat that sits securely  
on the seat cushion and against the  
seat back.  
Before you buy a child seat, it is important  
to note that your child’s weight, rather  
than age, determines the type of seat that  
is required.  
Ensure that the child restraint system  
is appropriate for the child’s weight  
and development, refer to page 105..  
Infant safety  
Jaguar strongly recommends the use  
Babies and small children who cannot sit  
up by themselves should be carried in an  
approved rear facing infant carrier, which  
should always be installed in a rear  
seating position.  
of LATCH seats, see page 106.  
Babies and small children who cannot sit  
up by themselves should be carried in an  
approved rear facing infant carrier, which  
should always be installed in a rear seat  
position.  
Jaguar recommends that a rear-facing  
seat with a harness is used for as long  
as your infant’s development allows.  
Note: For approved child restraints, you  
should contact your Jaguar Dealer.  
Do not use a forward-facing seat until  
your child is above the minimum weight of  
9 kg (20 lbs) and able to sit up unaided.  
Up to the age of two, a child’s spine and  
neck are not sufficiently developed to  
avoid injury in a frontal impact.  
We strongly advise that you do not buy or  
use a second-hand child seat. The seat  
may have been used inappropriately, or  
involved in an accident. In such  
circumstances, the seat may not protect  
your child.  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Safety  
CHILD SEATS  
PROPER CHILD SAFETY SEAT USE CHART  
Buckle Everyone. Children Age 12 and Under in Back.  
INFANTS  
TODDLER  
YOUNG CHILDREN  
WEIGHT  
Birth to 1 year at  
Over 1 year and Over Over 40 lb (18 kg)  
least 20 to 22 lb (9 to 20 - 40 lb (9 to 18  
Ages 4 - 8, unless 4ft  
9ins (145 cm).  
10 kg).  
kg).  
TYPE of SEAT Infant only or rear  
Convertible /  
Forward-facing.  
Forward-facing.  
Belt positioning  
booster seat.  
Forward-facing.  
facing, convertible.  
SEAT  
Rear-facing only.  
POSITION  
ALWAYS  
MAKE SURE and at least 20 lb (9  
kg) in rear-facing  
Children to 1 year  
Harness straps  
should be at or  
above shoulders.  
Most seats require  
Belt positioning  
booster seats must  
be used with both  
lap and shoulder  
belt.  
seats.  
Harness straps at or top slot for  
below shoulder level. forward-facing.  
Make sure the  
lapbelt fits low and  
tight across the  
lap/upper thigh area  
and the shoulder belt  
fits snug crossing  
the chest and  
shoulder to avoid  
abdominal injuries.  
All children age 12  
and under should  
WARNING  
All children age 12  
and under should  
All children age 12  
and under should  
ride in the back seat. ride in the back seat. ride in the back seat.  
Fitting the child seat  
2. Insert the metal tongue plate into the  
buckle. A positive click indicates that  
it is safely locked.  
Front and rear passenger seat belts have  
an automatic locking device for use with  
child seats.  
3. To fix the seat firmly, retract the belt  
back to the reel, a ratchet operation  
may be felt as the belt retracts.  
Continue to feed the belt back onto  
the reel until it fits snugly around the  
child seat.  
When engaged, this device allows the belt  
to be retracted (tightened) but not pulled  
out. When used to secure a child seat,  
therefore, the belt will automatically lock  
at any point to which it has retracted.  
1. Pull the seat belt all the way out to  
engage the locking device.  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Safety  
4. Push down on the child seat to ensure  
Ensure that you have removed all  
slack from the adult seat belt.  
any slack is taken in by the  
mechanism.  
Child restraint top tether anchorages  
and brackets  
(Coupe only)  
The above is a guide only. Depending on  
the features of a particular child seat, e.g.  
forward or rearward-facing, engage the  
locking device before or after attaching  
the belt, as convenient.  
Unbuckling the belt and releasing the  
child seat will allow the belt to resume its  
normal operation.  
General check list  
Follow the check list each time your child  
travels in the vehicle:  
Carefully follow the instructions  
provided by the manufacturer of the  
restraint system.  
Make sure your child falls into the  
correct weight range for the seat.  
JAG0192G  
Always use the appropriate child  
restraints and adjust harnesses for  
every child, every trip.  
The top tether brackets are positioned on  
the rear parcel shelf, under access  
covers, at the centre-line of each rear  
seating position.  
Avoid dressing your child in bulky  
clothing and do not place any objects  
between the child and the restraint  
system.  
Lift the top tether cover and connect the  
top tether to the bracket on the rear shelf.  
Adjust the length of the top tether strap to  
hold the top of the child seat against the  
vehicle seat back.  
Regularly check the fit of your child  
seat and replace seats or harnesses  
that show signs of wear.  
No child seat is completely  
child-proof. Encourage your child not  
to play with the buckle or harness.  
LATCH ANCHOR POINTS  
(Lower Anchorages and Tethers for CHild  
restraints)  
Never leave a child unsupervised in  
the vehicle.  
Ensure your child does not exit the  
vehicle from the side where there is  
traffic.  
Set your child a good example –  
always wear your seat belt.  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Safety  
!
WARNING:  
Child restraint anchorages are  
designed to withstand only those loads  
imposed by correctly fitted child  
restraints. Under no circumstances are  
they to be used for adult seat belts or  
for attaching other items or equipment  
to the vehicle.  
The rear seats of your vehicle are fitted  
with LATCH brackets that allow the  
LATCH child seat to be secured directly  
and easily to the vehicle body without the  
use of adult seat belts.  
Many injuries to children in accidents are  
caused by the incorrect fitting and  
tensioning of the adult seat belts, which  
are normally used to secure child seats.  
The LATCHsystem reduces the likelihood  
of incorrect fitting and is also quicker and  
simpler to use.  
JAG0196G  
The anchorage loops are accessible  
through two trimmed apertures at the  
back of the rear seat cushion. Their  
location is highlighted by the small tag  
labels with a child seat graphic. The  
anchorage loops are located  
approximately 60 mm (2.5 inches) below  
each label, Pull back the side of the trim  
as indicated, see illustration, to reveal the  
aperture and the anchorage loops.  
LATCH child restraint system  
Many LATCH child seats have two  
retractable lower catches that lock onto  
the anchorage loops, see page 108, and a  
strap that clips onto the top tether  
bracket, see page 106. The child seats  
may have quick release mechanisms to  
allow them to be removed easily.  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Safety  
Installing the LATCHISOfix seat  
4. Position the attachment legs just in  
front of the trimmed apertures for the  
LATCHISOfix anchorage loops (see  
illustration). Push the anchorage leg  
through the trimmed aperture to  
engage with the vehicle’s anchorage  
loop. There should be an audible  
click.  
5. Repeat Step 4 for the seat’s second  
anchorage leg.  
6. Using firm and even pressure on both  
sides, push the child seat rearwards  
until it is secured firmly against the  
seat back. Make sure you do not trap  
the top tether strap behind the child  
seat.  
JAG0197G  
To ensure that the LATCHISOfix child  
seat is installed safely, read all the  
information provided in this Section.  
7. If your vehicle is fitted with top tether  
anchorages brackets, make sure that  
the top tether strap is secured to the  
anchorage bracket, see page 106.  
!
WARNING:  
8. As a final check, firmly pull both sides  
of the seat to confirm that it is  
correctly locked in position.  
Always follow the manufacturer’s  
instructions supplied with the  
LATCHISOfix child seat. The following  
is to be considered only as a guide.  
Caution: Always follow the  
manufacturer’s instructions supplied  
with the LATCHISOFIX child seat.  
Fit the seat as follows:  
1. Push the adult seat belt buckles into  
their stowage recesses, to ensure  
they do not interfere with the fitment  
of the child seat.  
Removing the LATCHISOfix seat  
To remove the LATCHISOfix child seat,  
press the locking button on each side of  
the seat to release anchorage legs. If your  
vehicle is fitted with top tether  
anchorages, undo the top tether strap  
and lift the child seat from the vehicle.  
2. Make sure there is nothing  
obstructing the seat mounting  
mechanism at the anchorage points.  
3. Release the lever on the rear of the  
seat and fully extend the two  
attachment legs on the child seat.  
Ensure the hook at the end of each leg  
is open.  
BOOSTER CUSHIONS  
If a booster cushion is used, position the  
lap section of the adult seat belt over the  
child’s pelvis. The diagonal seat belt  
should rest on the child’s shoulder, not  
the neck.  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Facia and Controls  
Chapter  
5
CONTROL LOCATIONS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14  
Auto  
km  
l/100km  
Inst Fuel  
22  
15  
16  
17  
21  
20  
23 24  
29  
28  
27  
26  
19  
18  
25  
JAG0511N  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Facia and Controls  
1. Steering wheel audio switches (64).  
16. Gear selector (157).  
2. External light switches (71).  
17. Automatic speed limiter switch (180).  
18. Parkbrake switch (164).  
3. Jaguar sequential gear change down  
paddle (159).  
19. Dynamic stability control mode switch  
4. Speedometer (111).  
(166).  
5. Driver’s horn and air bag (63).  
6. Message centre (111).  
7. Tachometer (111).  
20. Engine START/STOP switch (50).  
21. Ashtray and cigar lighter (140).  
22. Steering column adjustment switch  
(62).  
8. Jaguar sequential gear change up  
paddle (159).  
23. Front fog lamp switch (75).  
24. Dimmer switch (140).  
9. Wiper and washer switch (65).  
10. Cruise control or adaptive cruise  
25. Rear fog lamp switch 75).  
control switches (169).  
26. Luggage compartment release switch  
11. Audio panel (184).  
(43).  
12. Hazard warning switch (76).  
13. Touch-screen display (121).  
14. Climate control panel (132).  
27. Forward alert switch (177).  
28. Fuel filler flap release switch (52).  
29. Hood release lever (234).  
15. Glove box compartment release  
Page numbers (shown in brackets) refer  
to pages in this handbook that have  
further relevant information.  
button (142).  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
Instruments  
INSTRUMENT PANEL  
OVERVIEW  
1
2
3
AVE FUEL  
A
MPG  
4
JAG0201N  
None of the instruments will show correct  
indications until the ignition system is in  
the ON condition, see page 50.  
3. Tachometer)  
Indicates engine speed in revolutions per  
minute (x 1 000) and is calibrated in  
increments of 250 rev/min.  
1. Speedometer  
Caution: Do not allow the needle to  
enter the red sector.  
Speed indication is in either:  
USA - miles per hour, the outer figures,  
and kilometres per hour on the inner ring.  
4. Fuel gauge  
The small arrow on the top of the fuel  
pump symbol indicates which side of the  
vehicle the fuel filler cap is located.  
Canada and Mexico - kilometres per  
hour, the outer figures, and miles per hour  
on the inner ring.  
The message centre will display the  
message FUEL LEVEL LOW when the  
fuel level is approximately 1/16 tank  
capacity, approximately a distance range  
of 48 to 64 km (30 to 40 miles).  
2. Message centre  
For more detailed information on the  
message centre, see page 118.  
Message centre illumination  
The message centre is lit at all times when  
the ignition is ON, see page 50.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
WARNING LAMPS AND  
INDICATORS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
AVE FUEL  
A
MPG  
20  
19  
18 17 16  
15  
14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7  
JAG0003N  
1. Anti-lock braking system (ABS) - USA  
17. Forward alert.  
only.  
18. Parkbrake on/brake fluid low - USA  
2. Anti-lock braking system (ABS) -  
only.  
Canada only.  
19. Parkbrake on/brake fluid low -  
3. Adaptive cruise control (ACC).  
4. Active front lighting system (AFL).  
5. Engine malfunction.  
Canada only.  
20. Left-hand direction indicator.  
RED warning lamps are for primary  
warnings. A primary warning must be  
investigated immediately by the driver or  
a Jaguar Dealer.  
6. Tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS).  
7. Air bag.  
AMBER warning lamps are for secondary  
warnings. Some indicate that a vehicle  
system is in operation, others indicate  
that the driver must take action and then  
report the fault to a Jaguar Dealer at the  
earliest opportunity.  
8. Right-hand direction indicator.  
9. Front fog lights.  
10. Rear fog light.  
11. Dynamic stability control (DSC).  
12. High beam.  
Other lamps within the instrument cluster  
indicate system status, such as blue for  
main beam and green for direction  
indicators, when in operation.  
13. Side lamps.  
14. Seat belt.  
15. Driver information center.  
16. Automatic speed limiter (ASL).  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
Lamp check  
If the indicator lamp is ON and the  
message PARK BRAKE APPLIED is  
displayed, it means that the parkbrake is  
applied but the vehicle is moving. Release  
the parkbrake or stop the vehicle when it  
is safe to do so.  
A lamp check is initiated when the ignition  
system is in the ON condition and lasts for  
three seconds (excepting the air bag  
warning lamp which will remain ON for six  
seconds). If any warning lamp remains  
ON after this period, investigate the cause  
before driving.  
If the indicator lamp is ON and the  
message BRAKE FLUID LOW with a RED  
priority light is displayed on the message  
centre, low brake fluid is indicated. In this  
case, loss of braking in one or both brake  
circuits may be imminent. Stop the  
vehicle gently and seek qualified  
assistance.  
Some warning lamps have associated  
messages displayed on the message  
centre.  
Note: Not all lamps are included in the  
lamp check, for example main beam  
headlights or direction indicators.  
Seat belt (Red)  
Brake (Red)  
The warning light stays on for  
60 seconds when the ignition is  
ON and:  
!
WARNING:  
If the message LOW BRAKE FLUID is  
displayed, do not drive the vehicle until  
the brake fault is rectified. Consult a  
Jaguar Dealer immediately.  
The driver’s seat belt is not fastened.  
Or after a passenger is sitting in the  
front seat and their seat belt is not  
fastened.  
Illuminates when:  
The indicator lamp should go out when  
the driver’s seat belt (and the front  
passenger’s if the seat is occupied) is  
fastened.  
the ignition system is ON and the  
parkbrake is ON  
Beltminder  
and, or the brake fluid is low  
The beltminder feature, which  
uses the same indicator as the  
seat belt warning, provides  
and, or there is a fault with the  
electronic brake system.  
reminders to the driver that the driver’s  
and/or front passenger’s seat belt is  
unbuckled.  
If the light is ON and there are no  
associated messages it means that the  
parkbrake is applied.  
If the vehicle is moving at or above  
16 km/h (10 mph) and the seat belt of an  
occupied seat is not fastened, the  
indicator lamp will flash.  
If the light flashes, there is a fault with the  
parkbrake system and the parkbrake  
cannot be applied.  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
The flashing will last for ten seconds and  
then repeat every 30 seconds for  
approximately five minutes or until the  
belt(s) is fastened or the vehicle stops.  
Active front lighting (Amber)  
Illuminates when there is a  
system fault. Report the fault to  
a Jaguar Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
Engine malfunction (Amber)  
Illuminates when the ignition  
If the warning indicator stays ON with the  
seat belt(s) fastened, report the fault to a  
Jaguar Dealer. It is safe to drive the  
vehicle with the light ON, provided that  
the seat belt(s) is properly fastened.  
Ensure that all occupants seat belts are  
fastened before driving.  
system is ON and remains on  
until the engine is started.  
If the indicator comes on when the engine  
is running then there is an engine  
malfunction.  
Note: If a heavy object is placed on the  
front passenger seat it may activate the  
Beltminder feature. It is recommended  
that the object be placed in the luggage  
compartment.  
Specialised diagnostic equipment is  
required to repair such faults. Report the  
fault to a Jaguar Dealer.  
The vehicle may go to limp-home mode,  
with the possibility of reduced engine  
performance. Drive with caution.  
Anti-lock braking system (ABS)  
(Amber)  
Dynamic stability control (DSC)  
(Amber)  
!
WARNING:  
If the ABS and brake warning  
indicators are ON at the same time, do  
not drive the vehicle until the fault is  
rectified. Consult a Jaguar Dealer  
immediately.  
The indicator will flash twice  
every second when DSC is  
operating.  
The message DSC NOT AVAILABLE will  
be displayed and the indicator lamp will  
be ON continuously if a fault is detected.  
Illuminates if a fault has been  
detected in the anti-lock brake  
system (ABS) or the electric  
When Trac DSC is selected the message  
TRAC DSC is displayed for four seconds  
and the warning indicator remains  
illuminated.  
parkbrake system. A warning message  
will appear to indicate either ABS or  
parkbrake fault.  
DSC OFF (normally aspirated engines  
only): If the system is turned OFF, a  
message DSC OFF will be displayed at all  
times and the warning indicator will  
remain ON.  
The brake system will continue to function  
normally, but without ABS braking.  
If the indicator lamp comes on or stays on  
after the bulb check cycle, the vehicle  
should be driven to a Jaguar Dealer at the  
earliest opportunity.  
When the system is turned back ON the  
warning indicator goes out and a  
message DSC ON will be displayed for  
four seconds.  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
Rear fog lamp (Amber)  
Illuminates when the rear fog  
Automatic speed limiter (Green)  
Illuminates when automatic  
speed limiter is active.  
lamp is switched ON.  
Adaptive cruise control (Amber)  
Front fog lamp (Green)  
Illuminates when adaptive  
cruise control is active to  
indicate that the vehicle is in  
follow mode.  
Illuminates when the front fog  
lamps are switched ON.  
Side lamps (Green)  
Forward alert (Amber)  
Illuminates when the side  
(parking) lamps are switched  
ON.  
Illuminates when Forward Alert  
is active.  
Direction indicators (Green)  
Air Bag (Amber)  
The appropriate indicator will  
flash when the column stalk is  
moved up or down to signal a  
Flashes if the air bag system or  
the Roll Over Protection  
System (Convertible only)  
turn. If a direction indicator fails, the  
audible ticking and lamp will sound and  
flash at twice normal rate when that  
indicator is selected.  
develops a fault. Then illuminates  
permanently until the fault has been  
diagnosed and cleared.  
Report the fault to a Jaguar Dealer  
immediately.  
Hazard warning lights  
When the hazard warning switch is used,  
both direction indicator tell-tales flash  
simultaneously.  
Tire pressure monitoring system  
(Yellow)  
Illuminates when one or more  
tires are significantly under  
inflated. The vehicle should be  
stopped as soon as possible and the tires  
checked and inflated to the  
recommended pressure.  
High beam (Blue)  
Illuminateswhen the high beam  
is switched ON or flashed ON.  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
AUDIBLE WARNINGS AND  
INDICATORS  
Various sounds are produced for warning and notification purposes as follows:  
Hazard or Condition  
External lights remain  
ON when the driver’s  
door is opened.  
Hazard warning  
indicators ON.  
Chime or tone/remedy  
A chime will sound until the lights are switched OFF or  
driver’s door is closed. The chime will not sound if the  
lighting control is in AUTO position.  
A ticking will sound until the hazard indicators are switched  
OFF.  
Direction indicators ON. A ticking will sound until the indicators are switched OFF.  
Memory 1, 2 or 3  
A short tone as the memory selection is saved.  
configuration saved.  
Air bag system failure.  
A tone sequence is repeated five times. Report the fault to  
a Jaguar Dealer as soon as possible.  
Seat belt reminder.  
Electric parkbrake.  
A chime will sound until an unfastened seat belt is  
fastened. The warning will cease if all the front seats are  
occupied and the seat belts are buckled, the vehicle is  
brought to a halt, the ignition is turned OFF or more than  
approximately five minutes has elapsed with the vehicle in  
motion, the ignition on and an occupied seat’s belt  
unbuckled.  
If the parkbrake is applied whilst the vehicle is moving a  
continuous chime is initiated; release the parkbrake. If  
there is a fault with the system which would prevent the  
application of the parkbrake, a brief sequence of chimes is  
initiated.  
Adaptive Cruise Control Multiple chime. Apply the brakes.  
(ACC) Driver intervene  
and Forward Alert.  
ACC low speed  
A chime will sound to indicate that the ACC system is no  
automatic switch off.  
Speed is over 15 km/h  
(9 mph) above the set  
limit speed.  
longer operating.  
A short warning chime.Reduce speed.  
Gear selector is not in  
Park with ignition OFF.  
A chime will sound. Select Park.  
Convertible roof starting High-pitched single chime.  
to open or close.  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instruments  
The Jaguar Smart Key A chime will sound. The remote handset should be inserted  
cannot be detected.  
into the starter control unit, see page 37.  
The Jaguar Smart Key A chime will sound for 60 seconds if the Jaguar Smart  
is to be removed from  
the starter control unit.  
Key is in the starter control unit and the driver’s door is  
opened. The remote handset should be removed from the  
starter control unit.  
DSC OFF (Normally  
A chime will sound.  
aspirated engines only)  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Information Displays  
4. Warning messages, red or amber, if  
system faults are detected. Status  
messages are displayed to indicate  
changes in state of certain vehicle  
functions, e.g. navigation, telephone.  
The clock can be shown when no  
other information is required to be  
displayed, see page 142.  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
The driver information centre display  
panel is situated within the instrument  
cluster between the tachometer and  
speedometer gauges.  
The information centre is active as soon  
as a door is opened for access.  
The primary function of the message  
centre is to inform the driver of the  
following:  
5. Trip computer information, including  
total distance covered by the vehicle,  
see page 119.  
warning messages  
6. Set trip computer information display  
relating to A, B or Auto trip computer,  
see page 119.  
temporary alert messages  
information messages.  
7. The fuel level gauge, which changes  
colour from blue to red when the fuel  
level drops to the reserve fuel level  
indicator. The small arrow on the top  
of the fuel pump symbol denotes  
which side of the vehicle the fuel filler  
cap is located.  
1
2
SETSPEED  
MPH  
55  
3
4
INFORMATION MESSAGES  
!
WARNING:  
5
6
7
10849  
If a red warning indicator is displayed,  
stop the vehicle as soon as possible  
when it is safe to do so.  
A :  
MILES  
238.7  
Most messages, when displayed have an  
associated warning light, red or amber,  
which will come on to indicate the  
message priority. Also from time to time  
information messages will be displayed.  
JAG0204N  
The message centre screen is divided into  
various zones displaying the following:  
1. Gear selection, automatic or manual.  
2. Speed control related information.  
3. Priority warning indicators.  
If more than one message is active, each  
is displayed in turn for two seconds in  
order of priority.  
Messages take priority over the trip  
computer data and will be displayed  
when the ignition is in the convenience  
mode, see page 42.  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Note: The message centre information  
messages and their meanings are detailed  
within the appropriate subject sections.  
TRIP COMPUTER  
The computer memory stores data for a  
journey or series of journeys until it is  
reset to zero.  
1
2
10849  
A :  
MILES  
238.7  
JAG0532N  
Odometer  
The odometer shows the total vehicle  
The displayed information is for guidance  
only, as it can be affected by traffic, road  
and weather conditions.  
distance travelled since the vehicle was  
new.  
Three independent memories are  
available, A, B and Auto. A and B  
memories can be set independently, while  
the Auto trip will reset after every ignition  
cycle as the vehicle moves.  
The odometer and trip distance reading is  
displayed in either miles or kilometres,  
depending on the units selected via the  
touch-screen, see page 128.  
Full trip computer information for the trip  
memories can be displayed on the vehicle  
touch-screen located in the centre  
console, while current selected trip  
computer information is displayed on the  
instrument cluster message centre.  
Changing the display  
To access the trip computer touch-screen  
settings:  
From the main Home touch-screen  
menu, select Vehicle.  
JAG0049G  
Press the TRIP button on the end of the  
left column stalk switch repeatedly to  
display the message centre data in the  
following order:  
Select Trip computer.  
Select requirements from the menu.  
A system flow chart is given on page 128.  
trip distance  
Trip computer message centre display  
average speed  
average fuel consumption  
range.  
Vehicle total distance travelled 1, trip  
distance 2 are displayed as well as,  
average fuel economy and average speed  
if selected via the touch-screen. Also A, B  
or Auto will be displayed, depending on  
the current memory selected.  
Trip distance (A, B and Auto)  
Distance travelled since the last memory  
reset. The maximum trip reading is 16,090  
kilometres (9,999.9 miles). The computer  
will automatically reset to zero if this  
distance is exceeded.  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Average fuel consumption (A, B and  
Auto)  
The average fuel consumption, litres per  
100 kilometres, miles per litre or miles per  
gallon, based on the accumulated  
distance travelled and the accumulated  
fuel used.  
Range  
This shows the predicted distance, miles  
or kilometres, that the vehicle should  
travel on the remaining fuel, assuming  
average fuel economy and fuel  
consumption stay constant.  
Average speed (A, B and Auto)  
The average speed since the last press of  
the reset button.  
ML/km (also Miles/litre)  
The distance display of imperial or metric  
units is selected via the touch-screen, see  
page 128.  
Display language  
The the display language is selected via  
the touch-screen, see page 128.  
Reset  
The resetting of the trip memories is  
carried out via the touch-screen, see  
page 128.  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
TOUCH-SCREEN  
1
Home  
Audio  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
73.0 F 70.5 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
2
3
JAG0007NAS  
Note: Information operation is given in the  
Information Displays, page 118, which  
incorporates the systems controlled via  
the touch-screen.  
3. HOME screen button: Press to return  
to the main HOME screen page from  
all facilities.  
System facilities  
Note: When the engine is stopped, for the  
touch-screen to remain active, press the  
engine START/STOP button again  
without pressing the brake pedal (ignition  
system ON).  
There are five major systems controlled  
via the touch-screen with their individual  
levels of operation and settings. They are  
as follows:  
Audio: Radio display AM/FM, CD.  
1. Touch-screen: When initially  
activated, the touch-screen will  
display the main Home screen. From  
this main Home screen all  
Climate: Air conditioning,  
Distribution, Seats, Heated steering  
wheel, Automatic air recirculation.  
touch-screen facilities and operations  
are initiated by pressing the relevant  
system touch-screen buttons and  
icons.  
Phone: Digit dialler, Phone book, Last  
ten calls (made, received, missed).  
Navigation: Destination, Stored  
locations, Navigation setup, Route  
options. Refer to navigation  
handbook.  
2. Touch-screen ON/OFF: Press once  
to turn the screen ON, press again to  
revert to screen-saver mode. A further  
press will turn the touch-screen OFF.  
When the engine Start/Stop button is  
pressed, the touch-screen is  
Vehicle: Security, Parking, Valet  
mode, Trip computer, Clock,  
Brightness, Contrast, System  
settings, Vehicle settings, Display  
settings.  
activated by the ON/OFF switch on  
the touch-screen console.  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Touch-screen use  
Where it is thought that guidance through  
the touch-screen menus is necessary,  
additional information has been given  
within that section or subject.  
!
WARNING:  
In the interest of road safety, only  
operate, adjust or view the system  
when it is safe to do so.  
Touch-screen display icons  
Touch-screen display icons are as  
follows, (they may not all be displayed at  
the same time):  
Caution: Always run the engine during  
prolonged use of the touch-screen.  
Failure to do so may discharge the  
vehicle battery, preventing the engine  
from starting.  
Return to the previous screen  
displayed.  
When the engine START/STOP button is  
pressed, the touch-screen can be  
activated by the ON/OFF switch on the  
touch-screen console.  
Warning triangle button  
indicating a warning pop-up  
message. Touch the pop-up to  
cancel. The warning message will be  
displayed on the message centre screen.  
The buttons surrounding the  
touch-screen display are referred to as  
hard buttons and should be pressed  
firmly. The touch-screen buttons are soft  
buttons and only require a short, light  
pressure to function. Do not use  
excessive pressure.  
Telephone: send button.  
Telephone: end call.  
Page up or increase setting to  
required value.  
When operating touch-screen buttons,  
always extend the tip of one finger, and  
withhold the thumb and remaining fingers  
from the screen. Touching the screen with  
more than one finger at a time may cause  
false inputs.  
Page down or decrease setting  
to required value.  
Direct access to the valet mode  
setting screen.  
Throughoutthehandbook, theexpression  
Select an item (or similar wording) means  
touch the on-screen button to select or  
alter the required item.  
Valet  
Telephone signal strength  
indicator.  
The handbook shows the on-screen  
menus, explains how to operate the  
controls and illustrates how to select or  
alter settings and requirements. After  
becoming familiar with the controls,  
follow the on-screen menus and prompts,  
to operate the system as required.  
Telephone battery charge  
indicator.  
No phone connected.  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Touch-screen care  
When initially activated, the touch-screen  
will display the main Home screen. The  
Home screen may also be displayed at  
any time by pressing the Home button on  
the screen surround.  
Caution: Care must be taken to avoid  
spilling or splashing drinks onto the  
touch-screen.  
Do not use any abrasive cleaners to clean  
your touch-screen. For approved screen  
cleaners, contact your Jaguar Dealer.  
Screen settings: The touch-screen  
brightness and contrast can be set to  
individual requirements, including  
dimming for night driving. This is  
accessed via the Vehicle settings system.  
Select Cont./Bright.  
The touch-screen inner bezel must be  
kept clean to maintain optimum  
performance. Finger marks and attracted  
dust should be regularly removed using a  
soft cloth and Jaguar approved cleaning  
agent.  
Vehicle  
Trip computer  
Clock adjust  
Cont./Bright.  
Syst. setting
Veh. settings  
Auto dimming  
On  
Where possible, avoid exposing the  
touch-screen to direct sunlight for long  
periods.  
Off  
Brightness  
Contrast  
PERSONALISED SETTINGS  
General Information  
12 : 26 pm  
The touch-screen provides touch-control  
of the vehicle Audio, Climate, Phone,  
Navigation and Vehicle systems, as fitted.  
JAG0207NAS  
Select Day or Auto dimming  
Day: Brightness and contrast can be  
adjusted to personal requirements by  
selecting the (+)or (-) buttons.  
Note: When the vehicle engine is stopped  
the touch-screen reverts to the stand-by  
mode. To activate the touch-screen press  
the engine Start/Stop button again.  
Vehicle  
Home screen display  
Trip computer  
Clock adjust  
Cont./Bright.  
Syst. settings  
Veh. settings  
Auto dimming  
On  
Home  
Audio  
Off  
Brightness  
Contrast  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
12 : 26 pm  
71.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
JAG0208NAS  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
JAG0206NAS  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Auto: Select either On or Off. Brightness  
and contrast are automatically adjusted  
by the ambient light level. As the light level  
decreases the touch-screen brightness  
will decrease until the full night screen  
level of brightness is initiated.  
Climate  
Phone  
Navigation  
Vehicle.  
Audio system  
Further adjustment of the touch-screen  
brightness can be achieved by using the  
(+) or (-) buttons in the Cont./Bright  
screen or by adjustment of the instrument  
panel dimmer switch, see page 140.  
The vehicle audio system interacts with  
Navigation, In-car Telephone and Climate  
Control systems.  
The audio system, see page 184, can be  
controlled from the switches on the  
touch-screen console, the touch-screen  
buttons and from the multi-function  
controls on the left-hand side of the  
steering wheel.  
Pop-up messages  
The operation of certain functions will  
cause a small message, pop-up, to  
appear overlaying the touch-screen  
display.  
The system structure is shown as a flow  
chart on page 127.  
Audio  
Settings  
Off  
Automatic climate control  
Sound  
On  
The automatic climate control system,  
see page 132, can be controlled from the  
touch-screen buttons.  
Audio  
Options  
PTY  
AutoStore  
Please wait..  
Cancel  
Phone  
Off  
On  
The communications system is  
composed of the following facilities:  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0209NAS  
phone  
The pop-up is mainly for information and  
will disappear automatically after a few  
seconds, or can be dismissed by  
digit dialler  
phone book  
last ten calls made, received, missed.  
touching the pop-up screen area.  
The telephone system, see page 210, is  
controlled from the touch-screen and the  
multi-function controls on the left-hand  
side of the steering wheel.  
If any action or adjustment is required the  
message will clearly indicate what is  
required and which button to touch.  
Touch-screen systems  
Navigation system  
There are five major systems controlled  
via the touch-screen with their individual  
levels of operation and settings. They are  
as follows:  
See the Navigation Handbook for detailed  
information on the operation of the  
navigation system.  
Audio  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Vehicle system  
Note: Celsius or Fahrenheit may be  
selected independently of metric or  
Imperial units.  
The following system functions are set  
using the touch-screen:  
trip computer  
Vehicle  
clock adjust  
0C  
0F  
Display set  
Preferences  
Button audio  
Vol. presets  
km km/h 1/100  
Mls. MPH MPG  
contrast and brightness  
system settings  
vehicle settings.  
Display language  
English UK  
Change  
The system structure is shown as a flow  
chart on page 127.  
12 : 26 pm  
Vehicle  
Languages and distance units  
The screen text and distance units are  
available in various languages and either  
Imperial or Metric units respectively.  
Dutch  
The required languages and units are  
accessed by selecting Vehicle on the  
main system Home screen, then  
selecting:  
Danish  
Finnish  
French  
Norwegian  
Trip computer  
12 : 26 pm  
Units change  
Preferences and then selecting from  
JAG0211NAS  
the menu.  
To change the language: The language  
choices are displayed as a list. Scroll up  
or down through the list using the up or  
down arrows.  
Vehicle  
0C  
0F  
Display set  
Preferences  
Button audio  
Vol. presets  
km km/h 1/100  
Mls. MPH MPG  
Note: The navigation system is not  
affected by the language change. To  
change the navigation system language  
display, refer to the Navigation Handbook.  
Display language  
English US  
Change  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0210NAS  
To change the units: The unit choices  
are selected by pressing the buttons  
either - km, km/h l/100 or Mls. MPH  
MPG.  
Temperature display is selected by  
pressing either °° °C or °°F.  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Timeout to home screen  
The Timeout to home screen (return to  
display the Home screen) can be  
adjusted.  
From the main Home screen select the  
Vehicle button.  
Vehicle  
Trip computer  
Clock adjust  
Cont./Bright.  
Syst. settings  
Veh. settings  
Trip  
Trip  
Auto  
Reset  
Unit Ch  
A
Distance  
Av. speed  
500 miles  
35 MPH  
B
Av. fuel 23 MPG  
Range 300 miles  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0231NAS  
1 Select the Syst. settings button.  
Vehicle  
Display set.  
Screensaver set.  
Prefs  
3
On  
2
Timeout to home  
screen  
Button audio  
Vol. presets  
Off  
50 seconds  
12 : 26 PM  
JAG0544NAS  
Select Display set 2 followed by Timeout  
to home screen either On or Off 3. Using  
the slider bar the time out can be adjusted  
from 10 seconds to five minutes.  
Note: An initial default setting of one  
minute is set if no time adjustment is  
made.  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Menu structure  
The following menu outlines represent the touch-screen Audio, Vehicle and  
Telephone system structure.  
Audio  
AM/FM  
CD  
Settings  
Sound  
Base  
Treble  
Balance  
Fade  
Options  
AF  
REG (Regionalisation)  
EON (Extended Other Networks)  
FM text  
PTY  
(Choose from itemised list)  
AM/FM  
CD  
Settings  
Sound  
Base  
Treble  
Balance  
Fade  
Options  
CD text  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Vehicle  
Trip computer  
Clock adjust  
Cont./Bright  
Syst. settings  
Veh. settings  
Trip A  
Trip B  
Auto  
Distance  
Av speed  
Av fuel  
Range  
Reset  
Distance  
Av speed  
Av fuel  
Range  
Reset  
Distance  
Av speed  
Av fuel  
Range  
Add/Delete trip  
Units  
Display set  
Screen saver  
Time out to home screen  
Preferences  
Units (Change from Metric to Imperial)  
Display language  
Button audio  
Vol. presets  
Audible  
Facilities volume set  
AVC (Automatic volume control)  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Trip computer  
Clock adjust  
Cont./Bright  
Syst. settings  
Veh. settings  
Adjust time  
Clock display  
12/24 hour  
Set  
Trip computer  
Clock adjust  
Cont./Bright  
Syst. settings  
Veh. settings  
Day  
Auto  
Brightness  
Contrast  
Trip computer  
Clock adjust  
Cont./Bright  
Syst. settings  
Veh. settings  
Display set  
Preferences  
Screen saver  
Time out to home screen  
Units (Change from Metric to Imperial)  
Display language  
Button audio  
Vol. presets  
Audible (On/Off)  
Facilities volume set  
AVC (Automatic volume control)  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Trip computer  
Clock adjust  
Cont./Bright  
Syst. settings  
Veh. settings  
Security  
2 stage unlock  
Drive away locking  
Parking  
Reverse mirror dip  
Valet mode  
(Enter a PIN security number)  
Phone  
Phone  
DigiDial  
Make a call  
Names  
Last 10  
Name search  
Made  
Received  
Missed  
Settings  
Register  
Undock  
Change phone  
Search new  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Information Displays  
Voicemail  
Enter voicemail No.  
Answer options  
Auto answer  
Caller announce  
Phone options  
Ringtones  
Phone ringtone  
Jaguar ringtone  
Phonebook  
Auto download  
Erase entire book  
Refresh book  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Control  
Climate Control  
In Auto mode air recirculation  
sensor detects pollutants and  
selects air recirculation when  
PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION  
!
WARNING:  
the level of pollution outside the vehicle  
reaches a certain level. The sensor  
response level can be adjusted on the  
touch-screen.  
Do not disconnect any pipes in the air  
conditioning refrigeration system. A  
refrigerant is used which can cause  
blindness if allowed to contact the  
eyes. If refrigerant should contact the  
eyes or skin, wash the eyes or affected  
area with cold water for several  
minutes. Do not rub. As soon as  
possible thereafter, obtain treatment  
from a doctor or eye specialist.  
Once the level of pollutants decreases, air  
recirculation will switch off.  
To set the automatic air recirculation  
sensitivity level of the pollution sensor:  
From the Climate Control home  
screen select Settings.  
Adjust the automatic air recirculation  
sensitivity setting as required by  
selecting the (+) or (-) buttons.  
The climate control panel is located in the  
centre console. There are two control  
facilities:  
A dedicated control panel located  
below the audio and CD panel for  
operation of basic features.  
Use of air conditioning  
Note: To prevent humidity build up inside  
the vehicle and possible screen misting,  
avoid driving with the air conditioning  
system off or in manual air recirculation for  
prolonged periods.  
A touch control and display unit for  
additional functions and personal  
settings.  
The climate control system features  
automatic temperature and air  
distribution control, which is programmed  
to maintain optimum levels of comfort  
within the vehicle in all but the most  
severe conditions.  
Air conditioning is an integral part of the  
climate control system, providing cooled  
and dehumidified air for occupant  
comfort. The dry airflow is also effective in  
preventing misting of the windows.  
While the air conditioner can be manually  
switched off, it is recommended that it is  
used in all climatic conditions throughout  
the year, preferably in AUTO mode.  
While the controls can be adjusted  
manually to satisfy individual  
requirements, allowing the system to  
function automatically (in AUTO mode) is  
by the simplest method of operation and  
is preferable in most operating  
conditions.  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Control  
Close all windows and the convertible top  
when the air conditioning is on to ensure  
satisfactory operation.  
If the air conditioning system is not  
used frequently, it should be run  
briefly at least once each week, with a  
cold setting. This will prevent the  
seals from drying out with subsequent  
refrigerant leaks.  
Surplus water produced by the  
dehumidifying process is expelled  
from the system via drain tubes  
beneath the vehicle. This may result in  
a small pool of water forming on the  
road when the vehicle is stationary  
and is not a cause for concern.  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Control  
AIR VENTS  
3
1
2 4  
2
1
2
1
2
1
JAG0508N  
The air vents provide fresh or heated air to  
the interior of the vehicle. Ensure that the  
air intake grille at the base of the  
windshield is kept clear of any  
obstruction.  
Automatic operation provides optimum  
comfort under most driving conditions.  
It is recommended that automatic  
control, AUTO, is selected as the  
normal operating mode.  
Air flow and direction can be adjusted  
with the thumbwheel controls 1 and  
direction vanes 2.  
Automatic control, AUTO, can be  
overridden at any time.  
AUTOMATIC CLIMATE  
CONTROL  
Automatic climate control provides  
efficient regulation of the vehicle  
environment without constant  
adjustments from the occupant.  
Sensors inside the vehicle monitor  
temperature, humidity 3 and direct  
sunlight 4. Do not obstruct these  
openings. In response to sensor  
indications, the electronic control system  
automatically adjusts the heat input,  
blower speed, air intake and airflow  
distribution to maintain the selected  
temperature(s) and reduce misting.  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Control  
Centre console control panel  
10  
Auto  
Climate  
Auto  
External  
Left  
62  
Auto  
F
Settings  
Econ  
Right  
71.5 F 70.0  
F
Climate  
Temp. sync.  
12 : 26 PM  
6
5
4
3
2
7
8
1
10  
JAG0496NAS  
1. Rear screen heat.  
To switch the climate control on  
With the ignition system ON, press the  
AUTO rotary control knob in the centre of  
the centre console control panel. The  
system will switch on in the auto  
operating mode. The control knob LED  
indicator will be illuminated.  
2. Temperature decrease, left-hand  
zone.  
3. Temperature increase, left-hand zone.  
4. Air recirculation and fresh air.  
5. AUTO climate control knob.  
6. Blower speed rotary control.  
Note: It is advisable to allow the system to  
stabilise before making large changes to  
the temperature setting, particularly at the  
start of a journey, refer to Temperature  
selection.  
7. Temperature decrease, right-hand  
zone.  
8. Temperature increase, right-hand  
zone.  
To switch the climate control off  
9. Windshield defrost and demist.  
The system can be turned OFF only from  
the options on the Climate touch-screen,  
see page 137.  
10. Climate control main touch-screen.  
Panel illumination  
The illumination level is adjusted by the  
common instrument panel dimmer  
control, refer to page 140.  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Control  
AUTO mode  
Air recirculation  
Automatic operation provides a  
controlled environment over a  
temperature range of 16°C to 28°C  
(59°F to 83°F)17°C to 31°C (61°F to 89°F)  
and should be regarded as the normal  
operating mode.  
Caution: Prolonged operation with  
recirculation selected and setting the  
automatic air recirculation sensor to a  
needlessly high level in cold and damp  
conditions, could result in interior  
screen misting.  
To select automatic climate control press  
the AUTO button, the LED illuminates to  
confirm selection.  
Press the recirculation button to select air  
recirculation. Selection is indicated by the  
screen symbol and the button LED  
illuminating.  
Select the required temperature.  
To deselect air recirculation, press the  
recirculation button again, or select  
AUTO.  
Front and rear screen heating and timed  
air recirculation may be selected in AUTO  
mode. Selecting any other control will  
cancel AUTO operation. The control knob  
LED indicator will be extinguished.  
Note: When air recirculation is selected,  
the sound of the airflow will change, this is  
normal.  
Temperature selection  
Windshield defrost and demist  
Separate controls allow the driver and  
passenger zone temperatures to be  
independently adjusted. Press the red  
buttons to increase temperature and the  
blue buttons to decrease temperature.  
To remove frost or heavy misting from the  
windshield, press the DEF button.  
The blower switches on automatically  
at a high level speed but the speed  
can be adjusted manually if required.  
Both driver and passenger temperatures  
are displayed on the touch-screen.  
Air conditioning switches on  
automatically (to dehumidify the air)  
and cannot be deselected.  
Pressing the driver’s buttons to select the  
maximum or minimum temperature  
settings causes the display to change to  
HI or LO respectively and cancel AUTO  
mode.  
Recirculation is cancelled and cannot  
be selected.  
The front screen heater and the rear  
screen heater and door mirror heaters  
switch on automatically, provided the  
engine is running.  
To quickly jump from HI or LO to a  
convenient mid range temperature  
of 22°C (72°F)22°C (72°F), press and hold  
AUTO for a few seconds.  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Control  
The button LED illuminates.  
Blower speed  
To deselect defrost mode, press AUTO or  
press the DEF button again.  
Rear heated screen  
Set the blower speed as required by  
adjusting the AUTO rotary control knob.  
The screen heater may be switched on  
and off in any mode, including system off,  
but only operates when the engine is  
running.  
When operating in AUTO mode, blower  
speed is controlled automatically and  
AUTO is displayed on the touch-screen.  
Any adjustment of the knob will cancel  
AUTO mode.  
The rear screen and door mirror heaters  
switch off automatically after 21 minutes.  
Note: In AUTO mode, the blower only  
operates at low speed, if heating is  
required, until the engine is warm.  
The screen heater may be manually  
deselected during the timed period using  
the push buttons.  
In cold ambient conditions, at the start of  
a journey, the rear screen heater will  
switch on automatically for the timed  
period, it will come on below-1°C (30°F).  
Heated seats and steering wheel  
The heated seats and steering wheel can  
be controlled only from the climate screen  
options on the touch-screen. See pages  
61 and 63 respectively.  
Air conditioning  
Touch-screen operation  
The climate control touch-screen is  
controlled via the Home touch-screen.  
Press the Climate button on the Home  
touch-screen.  
Press the AUTO rotary control knob to  
turn the air conditioning on.  
The air conditioning system is controlled  
automatically in AUTO mode to maintain  
the desired temperature and humidity  
(even if higher temperature settings are  
selected).  
Home  
Audio  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
ft  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
The air conditioning system is also  
switched on automatically in defrost  
mode (DEF) in order to dehumidify the air.  
71.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
JAG0011NAS  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Control  
The climate control main view is  
displayed, from which the climate control  
settings can be set.  
Temp. sync.  
Auto  
Synchronizes the driver and passenger  
climate control zones.  
Climate  
Auto  
External  
62  
Auto  
F
Settings  
Econ  
Left  
Right  
71.5 F 70.0 F  
Climate  
Blower speed control decrease and  
increase.  
Temp. sync.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0216NAS  
Settings  
Climate control display icons  
The climate control display buttons and  
icons are as follows:  
Access to the Settings control  
touch-screen to adjust personal climate  
zone settings, also access to the  
automatic air recirculation sensor control  
setting.  
Auto  
Auto climate control ON.  
Econ  
Econ ON/OFF. Economy mode turns off  
the air conditioning compressor and  
reduces power consumed by the climate  
control system which will reduce air  
conditioning performance. Econ mode  
can be turned OFF only from the climate  
screen options on the touch-screen.  
Prolonged use may cause the windows to  
mist.  
Distribution to windshield.  
Distribution to face.  
Climate  
Climate ON/OFF button.  
External temperature  
Distribution to feet.  
The external temperature is displayed at  
the top of the climate touch-screen zone.  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
Convertible Top  
Caution:  
OPENING THE CONVERTIBLE  
TOP  
The convertible top, will not  
operate unless the luggage  
separator is correctly located in the  
deployed position in the luggage  
compartment, see page 150 and  
that the luggage compartment lid is  
firmly closed.  
!
WARNING:  
Before opening or closing the  
convertible top, ensure that all  
occupants have moved their hands,  
fingers, hair, etc. clear of moving  
parts.  
Check that there is nothing in the  
rear area which could interfere with  
the top when folding down, e.g.  
ensure that the battery cover trim is  
fitted and secure.  
Do not place items on the tonneau  
panel or over the Rollover  
Protection Device covers.  
Do not attempt to operate the  
convertible top at temperatures  
below –15°C (5°F). This may cause  
damage to the fabric.  
If the convertible top is operated  
above 24km/h (15 mph) to  
excessive speeds there is a risk of  
damage to the convertible top.  
Do not attempt to OPEN the  
convertible top manually, as  
damage to the linkage mechanism  
may occur.  
JAG0486N  
1. Ensure that the ignition system is in  
the ON condition.  
The power operated convertible top and  
rear quarter windows, see page 88, are  
controlled by the switch located on the  
overhead console. The ignition system  
must be ON, see page 50. The top will  
latch and unlatch automatically. The top  
can be operated at speeds below  
24 km/h (15 mph), however, for safety it  
should not be opened or closed when the  
vehicle is being driven.  
2. Ensure that the luggage separator in  
the luggage compartment is in the  
fully deployed position. If it is not  
positioned correctly the proximity  
switches will not operate and the  
convertible top will not open, see  
page 151.  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
3.  
Caution: Do not at any time during the  
opening or closing of the convertible  
top press the engine START/STOP  
button as all movement will cease and  
the convertible top will have to be  
manually re-set.  
JAG00487N  
Press and hold the rear of the  
Convertible top manual re-set  
overhead console switch. (Do not  
release the switch until the top is fully  
open.).  
!
WARNING:  
It is advisable that two persons carry  
out this procedure so that the  
convertible top and tonneau cover are  
fully supported when required;  
although it is possible that this  
procedure may be carried out by one  
person with care.  
4.  
JAG0240G  
The rear quarter windows open,  
an audible warning sounds, and the  
top unlatches and starts to move, the  
tonneau closing panel opens. (The  
front windows will fully open. The door  
window switch will require to be  
pressed to close the window.).  
To manually re-set the convertible top:  
Ensure that the engine is not running and  
that the ignition system is OFF.  
5.  
JAG0241G  
When the top is fully open, the audible  
warning sounds again. The tonneau  
closing panel is fully automated and  
encloses the convertible top in the  
stowed position.  
6. Release the overhead console switch.  
Note: If at any period during the  
convertible top opening sequence the  
switch is released, all movement of the  
convertible top will cease.  
JAG0246G  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
Grasp the sides of the section, as shown,  
and pulling sharply. Remove the Allen key  
from its stowed position.  
1
2
JAG0247G  
3
From inside the luggage compartment,  
remove the vent screen to access the  
operating pump.  
JAG0420G  
The convertible top and tonneau cover  
movement can cease in any of the  
positions 1, 2 or 3, as shown.  
A
B
JAG0421G  
JAG0248G  
If the movement ceases in position 1,  
release the tension in the convertible top  
cover and tension bow (rear of convertible  
top) by lifting the front of the convertible  
top and pulling rearwards A.  
Insert the Allen key into the pump and  
rotate counter clockwise (approximately  
one turn).  
Lift the tension bow upwards B, and  
forwards to clear the tonneau cover).  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
Preparation for Winter  
Before the onset of Winter, it is advisable  
to coat the convertible top seals and  
respective body seals with a compound,  
such as Carbaflo KSP 105, to aid  
C
D
operation in freezing conditions.  
This action will need to be repeated at the  
start of each Winter to maintain  
protection.  
Care must be taken so that the compound  
does not come into contact with the  
convertible top material. For further  
advise you should contact your Jaguar  
Dealer.  
E
Luggage separator  
JAG0422G  
Caution: Luggage items should not be  
placed forward or on top of the luggage  
separator as it could cause damage to  
the separator.  
Lift the tonneau cover fully and support C.  
Pull the convertible top rearwards and  
downwards D so that it is fully stowed.  
Rest the tonneau cover in the closed  
position E.  
If the movement ceases in either positions  
2 or 3, lift the tonneau cover fully upright  
and support C, pull the front of the  
convertible top rearwards and  
downwards so that it is fully stowed D.  
Rest the tonneau cover in the closed  
JAG0242G  
position E.  
A luggage separator is located in the  
luggage compartment to prevent items  
from moving into the area where the  
convertible top is to be stowed.  
All positions: Turn the Allen key  
clockwise approximately one turn and  
return it to its stowed position, refit the  
rear seat centre section, luggage  
compartment vent screen and close the  
luggage compartment lid.  
When the convertible top is closed, the  
normal position for the luggage separator  
is in the retracted position with the  
partition positioned vertically.  
Switch ON the ignition system and start  
the engine. Press and hold the front of the  
convertible top switch until the  
convertible top is closed and fully latched.  
If the convertible top requires to be open,  
press and hold the rear of the switch.  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
To deploy the luggage separator  
To remove the luggage separator  
Caution: Do not place large objects  
underneath the luggage separator  
partition when deployed as damage to  
the convertible top may occur.  
1
2
3
1
JAG0243G  
Pull the handle on the luggage separator  
towards you. There is a lug on either side  
of the luggage separator: slide the lugs  
into the sliders on either side of the  
luggage compartment. The luggage  
separator will positively locate in the  
vertical position. A proximity switch, 1, is  
located in the separator assembly so that  
the convertible top will not open and  
retract until the separator is in the fully  
deployed position.  
JAG0244G  
With the luggage separator in the  
normally stowed position, pull the handle  
towards you, 1 and disengage the lugs  
from the sliders 2.  
Holding the centre of the main body of the  
luggage separator, rotate upwards 3,  
disengaging the main body of the luggage  
separator from the support brackets.  
Remove the luggage separator and  
When selected, if the convertible top does  
not open, the positioning of the luggage  
separator should be checked and ensure  
that the luggage compartment lid is firmly  
closed.  
retract the withdrawn partition section of  
the luggage separator into the main body.  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
To install the luggage separator  
CLOSING THE CONVERTIBLE  
TOP  
2
1. Ensure that the ignition system is in  
the ON condition.  
2. Press and hold the front of the  
overhead console switch, see page  
147. (Do not release the switch until  
the convertible top is fully closed and  
latched, and if required the rear  
quarter windows and front door  
windows are fully closed.).  
1
3
3. If the front windows are in any other  
position than fully down, they will  
retract to the fully down position on  
pressing the closure switch. As the  
convertible top starts to move the  
audible warning will sound.  
4
4. When the top is fully closed and  
latched, the audible warning sounds  
again and the rear quarter windows  
will close followed by the front door  
windows returning to the fully closed  
position.  
JAG0245G  
With the partition slightly extracted,  
position the luggage separator up to the  
support brackets with the front edge  
raised. Ensuring, that for both sides, the  
catch 1 will engage in the locating slot 2.  
Rotate the main body of the luggage  
separator 3 so that it sits down into the  
support brackets. Fit the partition lugs  
into the sliders 4 and retract the luggage  
separator partition into the normal  
stowage position.  
Note: If at any period during the  
convertible top closure sequence the  
switch is released, all movement of the  
convertible top will cease.  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
Manual closure of the convertible top  
If necessary, the convertible top can be  
closed manually, as follows:  
JAG0248G  
Insert the Allen key into the pump and  
rotate counter clockwise (approximately  
one turn).  
JAG0249G  
JAG0246G  
Pull the tonneau release cable, until fully  
extended. Close the luggage  
compartment lid.  
Grasp the sides of the section, as shown,  
and pull sharply. Remove the Allen key  
from its stowed position.  
JAG0247G  
From inside the luggage compartment,  
remove the vent screen to access the  
operating pump.  
JAG0250G  
Fully open the tonneau panel. It will  
self-support when fully opened.  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
2
1
JAG0251G  
JAG0253G  
From the left-hand side of the vehicle,  
place your right hand down the side of the  
folded convertible top. Ensure that the  
bottom of the convertible top, which  
includes the tension bow, is securely  
held. Securely hold the convertible top  
header assembly with your left hand. With  
both hands pull the whole of the  
Supporting the tension bow, lower the  
tonneau panel 1. Then lower the tension  
bow 2 onto the tonneau panel.  
convertible top up and forward.  
JAG0254G  
Remove the plug from the convertible top  
header trim.  
JAG0252G  
Ensure that the tension bow is fully raised.  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Convertible Top  
Support the front header. Insert the Allen  
key into the header panel key slot and turn  
clockwise until the top is securely latched  
and resistance is felt.  
Return the Allen key to its stowed  
position, refit the rear seat centre section,  
luggage compartment vent screen and  
the plug into the convertible top header  
trim.  
JAG0255G  
Message centre information displays  
Message  
Warning  
Light  
Priority  
Indicator  
Meaning  
HOOD NOT LATCHED  
None  
Red  
The convertible roof is not  
latched, check for security.  
The convertible roof is not  
correctly positioned. Open or  
close the convertible roof again  
and check for correct  
HOOD OUT  
OF POSITION  
None  
Amber  
Amber  
positioning.  
LUGGAGE COVER OUT None  
OF POSITION  
The luggage separator is out of  
position and should be checked,  
see page 152.  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Load Carrying  
Load Carrying  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
!
WARNING:  
(Coupe only): Extreme care must be  
taken when closing the luggage  
compartment lid when passengers  
are travelling in the rear seats.  
2
Locate heavy loads in the luggage  
compartment towards the front of  
the vehicle and secure them to stop  
them sliding. Loose items can be a  
hazard.  
Do not drive with the luggage  
compartment open as exhaust  
fumes can be drawn into the  
passenger compartment.  
To prevent permanent damage to the  
luggage compartment trim, it is advisable  
to distribute luggage weight evenly over  
the entire luggage floor area.  
1
JAG0256G  
LUGGAGE COVER  
(Coupe only)  
Caution: It is advisable that items are  
not placed on the luggage cover.  
The luggage cover is removed by  
releasing the two latches 1 on either side  
of the luggage cover and sliding it  
downwards and forwards so that the rear  
locating pegs 2 are disengaged from the  
trim and body. This will allow the luggage  
cover to be completely removed.  
To refit the luggage cover first locate the  
rear pegs 2. Then from the side of the  
vehicle, support the luggage cover and fit  
the front catch1, by pressing it firmly  
through the cover and closing the catch,  
this will hold the luggage cover in place.  
Repeat this procedure on the other side of  
the vehicle.  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission  
Chapter  
6
Gear selection and message centre  
indication  
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION  
The transmission system is designed to  
operate in two distinct modes,  
conventional automatic and Jaguar  
Sequential Shift.  
1
2
3
The automatic modes are accessed by  
the gear selector:  
D - Drive - automatic shifting.  
S - Sport - sport automatic shifting.  
The Jaguar Sequential Shift mode  
enables sequential manual gear selection  
in D (temporary) and S (permanent)  
modes via the steering wheel mounted  
paddles.  
Note: In addition to the standard shift  
patterns available in D and S, the  
transmission will adapt to differing driving  
conditions by modifying shift points based  
upon vehicle sensor information for road  
gradient, cornering, braking pressure and  
driving style.  
Gearshift interlock  
JAG0257G  
!
WARNING:  
The message centre indicates the  
position of the gear selector at the top of  
the message centre screen. When  
automatic selection is made the screen  
indicates either P, R, N or D, 1. When S is  
selected the indication changes to DS, 2  
and if manual selection is made the  
indication is from 1 to 6, 3.  
The brake pedal must be applied  
before selecting forward or reverse  
drive from a stationary position.  
A brake pedal and gearshift interlock  
system is incorporated in the automatic  
gear selector mechanism.  
To move the gear selector from Park:  
1. Ensure the ignition system is in the  
convenience mode or start the  
engine.  
P = Park – Use when parked. In this  
position the transmission is locked. Do  
not select if the vehicle is moving.  
2. Press the brake pedal.  
R = Reverse – Do not select if the vehicle  
is moving forward.  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission  
N = Neutral – Disconnects drive to the  
wheels. Use the parkbrake when stopping  
temporarily.  
S - Sport: The transmission operates  
automatically, but the gearshift points are  
modified to maximise the vehicle  
response in demanding driving  
conditions. This mode is not suitable for  
town or highway cruising.  
D = Drive – All six forward gears are  
changed automatically.  
S = Sport – All six forward gears are  
changed automatically with modified gear  
shift points.  
The automatic modes also offer additional  
features:  
Kick-down: Is operated when the  
accelerator pedal is fully depressed  
beyond the normal operating spring  
pressure to provide maximum engine  
performance. Kick-down is used in  
circumstances where rapid acceleration  
is required, such as when overtaking.  
Stationary vehicle  
When the vehicle is stationary the gear  
selector may be left in D, or S, unless the  
vehicle is to be parked. When stopping for  
extended periods, either select P or apply  
the parkbrake and select N.  
Shift inhibit  
Reverse is inhibited when the vehicle is  
moving forward.  
Kick-down causes the transmission to  
change down to the lowest gear possible  
to achieve maximum acceleration. The  
gear engaged depends on the road speed  
at the time of kickdown.  
Note: Reverse inhibit will not function in  
limp-home mode.  
Driver type recognition: The  
Note:  
transmission monitors driving style and in  
combination with sensors in the vehicle,  
varies the shift schedule, fast-off, corner  
recognition and shift adapt under braking  
functions proportionally with driving style.  
The engine is limited to a maximum  
speed of 4 500 rev/min. when N or P  
is selected.  
After selecting forward or reverse  
drive ranges from N or P, wait briefly  
for the transmission to engage before  
accelerating.  
Note: This feature is only active in S -  
Sport mode.  
Fast-off: Activated when rapidly lifting-off  
the accelerator pedal and takes account  
of road gradient. This feature inhibits  
up-shifts enhancing performance.  
Automatic operating modes  
There are two available automatic modes:  
D - Drive: All six gears are changed  
automatically. The shift points are  
determined by accelerator pedal position  
and road speed to provide the best  
balance of performance, refinement and  
fuel economy for the large majority of  
driving conditions.  
Note: This feature will vary its activation,  
dependant upon the driver type if S -  
Sport is selected.  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission  
Shift adapt under braking: Under  
Dynamic stability control (DSC): When  
DSC is switched ON and the system is  
activated, the transmission selects a shift  
pattern to suit traction control conditions.  
braking, the transmission will vary the  
down-shift point in proportion to braking  
effort and road gradient. This feature is  
realised in conjunction with positive  
torque, resulting in a smoother  
down-shift.  
Manual operating modes - Jaguar  
Sequential Shift  
Shifts in the Jaguar Sequential Shift  
manual mode are optimised to provide a  
rapid response to gear shift requests.  
Up-shift requests are optimised for  
performance via the short shift function,  
this will result in a firmer shift feel than in  
automatic modes. Down-shift requests  
realise a throttle blip during the shift event  
resulting in improved shift feel.  
Note: This feature will vary its activation,  
dependant upon the driver type if S -  
Sport is selected.  
Positive torque: Provides throttle blips  
on down-shifts under braking, improving  
shift feel.  
Note: This feature is only active in S -  
Sport mode.  
The Jaguar Sequential Shift modes can  
be accessed either temporarily or  
permanently.  
Corner recognition: Inhibits up-shifts  
during cornering to provide improved  
vehicle balance.  
Temporary manual gear selection:  
When the gear selector is in the D  
position, manual mode may be directly  
accessed by the single action of  
operating the steering wheel mounted  
shift paddles.  
Note: This feature will vary its activation,  
dependant upon the driver type if S -  
Sport is selected.  
Road gradient adaption: When the  
vehicle is being driven on roads with uphill  
gradients, the transmission adapts the  
shift pattern to make better use of engine  
power.  
This convenience feature allows  
immediate but temporary use of the shift  
paddles whilst the gear selector is in D.  
When driving on roads with long downhill  
gradients, the transmission may  
If continued use of manual mode is  
required, the gear selector may be  
subsequently moved to the S position to  
enter permanent manual mode in the  
currently selected gear.  
automatically select a lower gear to  
increase engine braking. Selecting S will  
increase the tendency of the transmission  
to select a lower gear in these conditions,  
further increasing engine braking.  
If the gear selector remains in the D  
position, temporary manual mode will be  
held whilst the driver is accelerating,  
decelerating, cornering or continuing to  
request shifts via the paddles.  
Note: It is also possible to manually select  
a lower gear to increase engine braking via  
use of the shift paddles.  
Cruise control: When cruise control is  
active, the transmission selects a shift  
pattern to suit cruise control operation,  
see page 169.  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission  
The transmission will revert to automatic  
Manual operation  
operation after a short period of driving at  
steady speed; alternatively the shift-up (+)  
paddle may be held for a short period  
(approximately one second) to return  
directly to automatic operation in D.  
JAG0258G  
Permanent manual gear selection:  
Select the S position, permanent manual  
mode then is accessed by the operation  
of the steering wheel mounted shift  
paddles.  
JAG0048G  
The message centre will highlight the  
currently selected gear.  
To shift-up, briefly pull the shift-up (+)  
paddle on the right-hand side of the  
steering wheel towards you.  
To exit from the Jaguar Sequential Shift  
permanent manual mode, move the gear  
selector to the D position. The  
transmission will revert to the D automatic  
shift mode.  
To shift-down, briefly pull the shift-down  
paddle (-) on the left-hand side of the  
steering wheel towards you.  
The message centre display will change  
to highlight the requested gear.  
Note: The transmission will inhibit  
up-shifts and down-shifts if the requested  
shift would result in an engine speed  
outside the normal operating range of the  
engine. If this occurs, the message centre  
will briefly display the requested gear  
selection, but will return to displaying the  
current gear.  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission  
The Jaguar Sequential Shift mode also  
Limp-home mode  
has the following features:  
Kick-down: Operation of kick-down in  
Jaguar Sequential Shift mode will  
over-ride the currently selected gear. The  
lowest available gear will be selected for  
maximum acceleration and will be  
highlighted in the message centre display.  
Subsequent manual shifts may then be  
selected as usual.  
!
WARNING:  
The driver should be aware that the  
vehicle’s performance will be reduced  
and must take this into account when  
driving. Also the use of the Jaguar  
Sequential Shift paddles will be  
disabled. In this event consult a Jaguar  
Dealer immediately.  
Positive torque: Provides throttle blips  
on down-shifts, improving shift feel and  
response.  
In the unlikely event of an electrical or  
mechanical failure, transmission  
operation will be limited. The vehicle gear  
selector ranges P, R, N, D can still be  
used to enable the vehicle to be driven to  
a safe area.  
Shift assist: The transmission will  
automatically up-shift at the engine speed  
redline in Jaguar Sequential Shift mode  
as if commanded manually.  
Message centre display  
The transmission will automatically  
down-shift when the engine rpm drops  
too low for the currently selected gear.  
The message centre may display the  
following messages with associated  
warning indicators:  
When the vehicle approaches, or comes  
to rest, second gear is automatically  
selected.  
ENGINE SYSTEMS FAULT (Red)  
RESTRICTED PERFORMANCE (Red or  
Amber)  
Subsequent pullaways will occur in  
second gear, unless the accelerator pedal  
demand is high or a down-shift is  
manually selected, in which case, first  
gear will be selected.  
TRANSMISSION FAULT (Amber)  
If any of these messages are displayed it  
is likely that loss of power or driveability  
will be experienced. Seek qualified  
assistance as soon as possible.  
In all cases the message centre will  
display the current gear.  
Final drive unit  
Note: If a down-shift is requested which  
would normally result in an engine speed  
outside the normal operating range during  
sustained braking the transmission will  
indicate and hold the requested gear in  
the message centre display. The  
transmission will then commence the  
down-shift when the engine speed is  
within the normal operating speed.  
Caution: Although the final drive unit is  
a fill for life unit, if your vehicle is used  
for a race event or test track day, then  
following the event the final drive unit  
lubricant should be changed. Contact  
your Jaguar Dealer.  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brakes  
Brakes  
ABS optimises tire to road adhesion  
PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION  
under maximum braking conditions  
though it cannot provide increased  
cornering ability.  
Anti-lock braking system (ABS)  
!
During normal braking the ABS will not be  
activated. However, if the braking force  
applied begins to exceed tire to road  
adhesion the ABS will automatically  
activate, preventing the road wheels from  
locking.  
WARNING:  
It remains the driver’s responsibility  
to drive safely according to  
prevailing conditions.  
The fact that a vehicle is fitted with  
ABS must never allow the driver to  
be tempted into taking risks which  
could affect his or her safety or that  
of other road users.  
In these circumstances a pulsating effect  
will be felt from the brake pedal indicating  
that the system is functioning. The  
pulsating effect is due to small  
fluctuations in pressure supplied to the  
brakes by the system to maintain full tire  
and road adhesion.  
The addition of ABS cannot  
overcome the consequences of  
trying to stop in too short a  
distance, cornering at too high a  
speed, or the risk of aquaplaning.  
Under severe braking on some road  
surfaces tire noise may be apparent even  
though the wheels will at no time become  
locked.  
The driver should always take road  
conditions into account. A slippery  
road surface always requires more  
braking distance for a given speed,  
even with ABS. A possible increase  
in stopping distance compared to  
locked wheels may occur during  
ABS operation on slushy snow,  
gravel, sand, or some heavily  
ABS monitoring  
Caution: Consult a Jaguar Dealer  
immediately if the warning light comes  
on while driving, a system failure is  
indicated.  
The ABS control module monitors the  
ABS electrical system from ignition switch  
ON to ignition system OFF. Any  
malfunction will be indicated by the  
anti-lock warning light coming on and a  
message ABS FAULT will be displayed  
by the message centre.  
corrugated or ridged warning  
sections of road surfaces.  
This system helps to prevent the road  
wheels from locking and skidding during  
emergency braking, assisting the driver to  
maintain full steering and directional  
stability.  
Should a fault develop in the ABS system,  
the brake system will still operate  
conventionally and with the same  
standard of performance as vehicles not  
equipped with ABS.  
The factor controlling ultimate stopping  
distance and cornering ability is tire and  
road adhesion.  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brakes  
Emergency Brake Assist (EBA)  
HINTS ON DRIVING WITH ABS  
For optimum ABS performance these  
instructions on braking techniques during  
ABS operation should be followed:  
!
WARNING:  
The EBA system is an additional safety  
system; it is not intended to relieve the  
driver of his or her responsibility for  
exercising due care and attention when  
driving.  
Do not release brake pressure when  
the pulsating effect is felt. Maintain a  
constant pressure until the  
manoeuvre is completed.  
To familiarise yourself with the feel of  
the brake pedal during ABS braking,  
practise an emergency stop  
The EBA system measures the rate at  
which the brake pressure increases. If the  
system detects an emergency braking  
situation, EBA automatically initiates the  
full braking effect. This can reduce  
stopping distances in critical situations,  
which can help an inexperienced driver to  
stop in the same distance as an  
procedure, always making sure it is  
safe to do so. With the seat belts fitted  
to all occupants, drive the vehicle at  
32 km/h (20 mph) and brake sharply.  
ABS enables the driver to steer  
around obstacles during emergency  
braking. However, the consequences  
of turning sharply at high speed  
cannot be overcome by the ABS.  
experienced driver.  
Any malfunction will be indicated by the  
message BRAKE ASSIST FAULT  
displayed by the message centre.  
Increased brake pedal effort may be  
required to slow the vehicle. Seek  
qualified assistance as soon as possible.  
Do not attempt to pump the brakes to  
avoid skidding as this can interfere  
with the ABS operation. The ABS will  
not allow the wheels to skid under  
normal road conditions.  
The ABS will tend to keep the vehicle  
straight during braking. Because  
braking distances may increase under  
certain road conditions, it is  
necessary to plan and make turning  
manoeuvres as early as possible.  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brakes  
Inadvertent operation of the parkbrake  
ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE  
(EPB)  
whilst the vehicle is in motion, abov  
3 km/h (1.8 mph), will cause the message  
PARK BRAKE APPLIED to be displayed  
on the message centre, the warning light  
in the instrument cluster will be  
illuminated and a warning chime will  
sound.  
1
2
If the parkbrake is applied whilst the  
vehicle is moving, releasing the switch will  
disengage the parkbrake. The parkbrake  
cannot be applied whilst the vehicle is  
moving and the throttle pressed.  
Note: If the vehicle is in motion, the  
parkbrake should only be used as an  
emergency brake.  
JAG0045L  
The switch which operates the parkbrake  
is mounted on the centre console to the  
rear of the gear selector.  
Caution: Take care that the vehicle is  
safely parked to prevent it from rolling  
if you wish to leave the parkbrake off.  
However, it is advisable to always use  
the parkbrake.  
To engage the parkbrake 1: Pull the  
parkbrake switch upwards and release.  
The switch will return to the neutral  
position. The parkbrake warning/brake  
fluid low warning light on the instrument  
cluster will illuminate.  
The warning light in the instrument cluster  
will remain on for a short time if the  
parkbrake is applied when the ignition  
system is reverted to the convenience  
mode, see page 42.  
The Drive Away Release feature allows  
the parkbrake to release automatically as  
the vehicle is driven away.  
If a fault in the system is detected, a  
message PARK BRAKE FAULT or  
CANNOT APPLY PARK BRAKE will be  
displayed. Seek qualified assistance as  
soon as possible.  
To disengage the parkbrake 2: With the  
ignition system in the ON position or with  
the engine running, apply the foot brake  
and press the parkbrake switch down.  
If the battery has been discharged or  
disconnected a message APPLYFOOT  
AND PARKBRAKE will be displayed  
when the ignition is next switched on.  
Depress the footbrake and pull the  
parkbrake switch up to apply the  
parkbrake. This is required to reset the  
parkbrake system. The parkbrake will  
now function correctly.  
If the parkbrake is applied while the  
vehicle is stationary and D or R is  
selected, applying the throttle will  
automatically release the parkbrake.  
The parkbrake is also automatically  
released when the gear selector is moved  
from the P position.  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stability Control  
Stability Control  
Trac dynamic stability control (Trac  
DSC)  
PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION  
Dynamic stability control (DSC)  
Trac DSC is an additional feature where  
DSC settings are optimised for maximum  
traction in difficult conditions, such as  
deep snow, sand or gravel. This makes  
greater traction possible, without having  
to completely lose the benefits of DSC,  
however, vehicle stability may be  
reduced.  
!
WARNING:  
The fact that the vehicle is fitted with  
DSC must never allow the driver to be  
tempted into taking risks which could  
affect his/her safety or that of other  
road users. In all cases it remains the  
driver’s responsibility to drive safely  
according to the prevailing conditions.  
Caution: Vehicle safety could be  
reduced by inappropriate use of Trac  
DSC. Trac DSC should only be used  
when necessary for the prevailing  
conditions:  
Dynamic stability control is operational  
whenever the engine is running, unless it  
has been switched off. When the system  
is operating, the warning light in the  
instrument cluster will flash.  
In deep snow.  
To maintain the movement of the  
vehicle on soft or loose surfaces  
e.g. gravel, sand.  
The DSC system controls the anti-lock  
braking system (ABS), traction control  
and yaw control of the vehicle.  
When snow chains are fitted.  
The DSC system assists the driver in  
retaining directional control of the vehicle  
in situations where the vehicle is sliding  
(understeer or oversteer). It must not  
encourage the driver to drive beyond the  
limit of adhesion or at speeds higher than  
those suitable for the prevailing road and  
traffic conditions.  
It applies braking pressure to individual  
wheels if excessive variation is detected.  
This ensures that the vehicle follows the  
driver’s intended direction of travel.  
Traction control will intervene to prevent  
wheel spin by automatically reducing the  
power output from the engine and  
applying braking to individual wheels.  
This improves acceleration, particularly  
on surfaces with uneven friction, for  
example, one wheel on ice the other on  
tarmac.  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Stability Control  
Switching DSC ON:  
If DSC is OFF:  
USING STABILITY CONTROL  
Press and release the DSC switch.  
The DSC system will switch on, the  
message centre will temporarily  
display DSC ON.  
The warning light on the instrument  
cluster will be extinguished.  
Stability control indicator - All vehicles  
A system malfunction is indicated by the  
message DSC NOT AVAILABLE in the  
message centre and the amber priority  
warning light. The instrument cluster  
warning light will also be lit.  
JAG0262L  
It is safe to drive the vehicle but the DSC  
system will not activate under wheel spin  
or slide conditions. You should seek  
qualified assistance as soon as possible.  
Switching between DSC and Trac DSC  
- All vehicles  
Press and hold the DSC switch for  
less than three seconds.  
Computer active technology system  
(CATS)  
The message centre will temporarily  
display either Trac DSC or DSC ON.  
If the message centre displays the  
message CATS SYSTEM FAULT, a fault  
has been detected in the adaptive  
damping system. Seek qualified  
assistance as soon as possible.  
The warning light on the instrument  
cluster will illuminate while Trac DSC  
is selected.  
The warning light will flash when DSC  
or Trac DSC is active.  
Note: If cruise control is engaged it will  
automatically disengage if stability control  
activates.  
Switching between DSC OFF and ON -  
Normally aspirated engines only  
Switching DSC OFF:  
Press and hold the DSC switch for  
more than three seconds.  
The message centre will temporarily  
display DSC OFF and a warning  
chime will sound.  
The warning light on the instrument  
cluster will illuminate.  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parking Aid  
Parking Aid  
PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION  
USING THE PARKING AID  
Touch-screen  
!
WARNING:  
To set the preferences of the parking  
assist, the settings are accessed via the  
touch-screen Home screen and Veh.  
settings.  
It remains the driver’s responsibility  
to be vigilant when reversing. Small  
children or animals may not be  
detected by the system.  
It remains the driver’s responsibility  
to detect obstacles and estimate  
the car’s distance from them. Some  
overhanging objects, barriers, thin  
obstructions or painted surfaces  
which could possibly cause  
Vehicle  
Reverse  
On  
Security  
Parking  
Off  
mirror dip  
Valet mode  
Vol. presets  
damage to the vehicle may not be  
detected by the system. Always be  
vigilant when reversing.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0264NAS  
Caution:  
Select Parking (1).  
Once the system has been  
There is a link to Vol. presets in order that  
the volume of the parking assist warning  
beeps may be adjusted.  
activated by selecting reverse or  
using the switch, the rear sensors  
are active when the gear selector is  
in neutral. Therefore, if an obstacle  
is detected a tone will sound.  
Note: The volume adjusts both front and  
rear speaker volume.  
Objects moving away from the  
vehicle will be reported. However,  
whilst driving away, object warning  
may be temporarily reported due to  
ground reflection.  
Home  
Parking Aid Alert  
Audi
Clim
Phon
The Park Assist System is automatically in  
standby when the ignition is turned on.  
Navi
Vehic
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
JAG0265NAS  
When the reverse parking aid is active, a  
pop-up screen is initiated displaying the  
area of the vehicle. This can be cancelled  
by touching the screen within the pop-up  
area.  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parking Aid  
Rear parking aid  
Rear fitted accessories  
Particular care must be taken when  
reversing with rear fitted accessories e.g.  
bicycle carrier, as the rear park assist will  
only indicate the distance from the  
bumper to the obstacle.  
System Fault  
The parking assist may sound spurious  
tones if it detects a frequency tone using  
the same band as the sensors.  
JAG0267G  
When reverse gear is selected and the  
ignition is on, if obstacles are detected  
within operating range, as shown in the  
illustration below, the rear parking assist  
automatically provides an audible  
proximately warning to the nearest  
detected object.  
Cleaning the Sensors  
Do not clean the sensors with abrasive or  
sharp objects or materials.  
For reliable operation, the sensors in the  
rear bumpers should be kept free from  
ice, frost and grime.  
When using a high pressure spray the  
sensors should only be sprayed briefly  
and not from a distance of less than  
20 cm (8 inches).  
2
1
JAG0270G  
1 is approximately 60 cm (24 inches).  
2 is approximately 180 cm (71 inches).  
The beep tone increases in rate as the  
vehicle approaches the obstacle.  
The rear parking assist beep will become  
continuous when the obstacle is detected  
at or within 30 cm (12 inches) from the  
vehicle.  
Note: The outer rear sensors 1 will show  
visual detection on the message centre  
before the audible warning is given.  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cruise Control  
Cruise Control  
PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION  
USING THE CRUISE CONTROL  
Setting vehicle speed  
1
!
WARNING:  
Only use cruise control when  
conditions are favourable, for example,  
straight, dry, open roads with light  
traffic.  
When you are travelling at the speed you  
require, which must be above 30 km/h  
(18 mph), roll the speed adjustment  
control 1 upwards or downwards to  
increase or decrease speed.  
3
2
JAG0035G  
The cruise (speed) control system can be  
used by the driver to maintain a selected  
vehicle speed above 30 km/h (18mph)  
without the driver having to use the  
accelerator.  
Cruise control will engage and maintain  
the set speed and you can remove your  
foot from the accelerator pedal.  
Adjustment controls on the steering  
wheel allow the driver manual control of  
the system. Brake and clutch operations  
also influence the cruise control system.  
Note: Cruise control will automatically  
disengage when the brake pedal is  
pressed or when the vehicle speed falls  
below 30 km/h (18 mph).  
SPEED ADJUSTMENT CONTROL 1  
thumb wheel is used to engage cruise  
control initially by rolling it upwards. It is  
also used to increase or decrease the set  
speed.  
Changing the speed  
CANCEL 2 cancels cruise control but  
retains the set speed in memory.  
RESUME 3 engages cruise control after it  
has been cancelled.  
JAG0272G  
There are two ways to change the set  
speed:  
Accelerate or decelerate to the  
desired speed then roll the speed  
adjustment control upwards (+).  
Increase or decrease the speed by  
rolling the speed adjustment control  
upwards (+) or downwards (-) until the  
desired speed is obtained.  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cruise Control  
Note: The set speed can be increase or  
Automatic switch off  
decrease the speed in steps of 1 mph  
(2 km/h) by rolling the speed adjustment  
control upwards (+) or downwards (-)  
briefly until the desired speed is obtained.  
Cruise control will switch off but the set  
speed will remain in the memory when:  
The CANCEL button is pressed.  
The brake pedal is pressed.  
Resuming the speed  
Speed falls below 30 km/h (18 mph).  
If the vehicle is accelerated above the set  
speed, then the set speed will be resumed  
when the accelerator pedal is released.  
Neutral, Park or Reverse gear  
positions are selected.  
Dynamic stability control is operating.  
If CANCEL is pressed, or the brake pedal  
is pressed, the cruise control will  
disengage but the set speed memory will  
be retained. Press RESUME and the  
vehicle will return to the set speed.  
The difference between the actual and  
set speed is too great.  
When the vehicle reaches a maximum  
speed of 192 km/h (120 mph).  
Note: Cruise control will not resume at  
speeds below 30 km/h (18 mph).  
The accelerator pedal is used to  
accelerate beyond the set speed for  
too long a period.  
RESUME will not operate if the ignition  
has been turned OFF.  
Caution:  
RESUME should only be used if the  
driver is aware of the set speed and  
intends to return to it.  
It is not recommended to resume  
set speed when a low gear is  
selected as excessive engine  
speeds will occur.  
Cruise control will switch OFF and clear  
the memory when:  
The ignition system is switched OFF.  
A fault occurs. The cruise control  
system will switch OFF and cannot be  
used until the fault is cleared.  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cruise Control  
Message centre information displays  
Message  
Warning  
Light  
None  
Priority  
Indicator  
None  
Meaning  
CRUISE  
ENGAGED  
Displayed when cruise control  
system is operating.  
CRUISE  
OVERRIDE  
None  
None  
Driver is pressing the accelerator  
pedal overriding cruise control  
function. Message will disappear  
when accelerator pedal is  
released and cruise control  
speed is resumed.  
CRUISE  
None  
None  
None  
None  
Driver has cancelled cruise  
control or is braking.  
Cruise control or adaptive cruise  
control malfunction.  
CANCELLED  
CRUISE NOT  
AVAILABLE  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Speed Limiter (ASL)  
Automatic Speed Limiter (ASL)  
When ASL is selected, the instrument  
panel telltale status light will illuminate.  
When the ASL button is pressed again,  
the light will extinguish, ASL will be  
cancelled and cruise control will be  
available again.  
PRINCIPLE OF OPERATION  
!
WARNING:  
Automatic Speed Limiter (ASL) set  
speeds must be within local speed  
restriction limits. The driver must  
always ensure that a safe speed is set,  
taking into account the prevailing  
traffic and road conditions.  
USING THE ASL  
Setting a speed limit  
ASL can be used in a situation where  
varying vehicle speed is likely but a  
maximum speed must not be exceeded.  
1
For example, where a local speed limit is  
80km/h (50mph), the set speed could be  
at that limit or just under. The driver is  
then safe in the knowledge that the local  
speed limit cannot be exceeded while  
ASL is operating.  
2
3
JAG0479G  
1. Press the ASL button.  
2. Use the thumb wheel 1 to set the  
required speed.  
While a speed is being set or altered  
the message centre display in the  
instrument panel will show the  
selected speed.  
3. The set speed can be adjusted at any  
time by rotating the thumb wheel 1.  
JAG0500N  
If ASL is not selected, cruise control is  
always available by simply rotating the  
thumb wheel on the right hand side of the  
steering wheel to set a cruising speed.  
The ASL button allows the driver to select  
between cruise control and the automatic  
speed limiter. The ASL can be set to any  
speed between 30km/h (18mph) and  
240 km/h (150 mph).  
LIMITER SET  
XXX MPH  
Note: The message is also displayed at  
other times as an information display.  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Speed Limiter (ASL)  
When ASL is selected and a set speed  
There are three categories of over limit  
inserted, the engine will respond normally  
up to the set speed. Further accelerator  
pedal pressure will not increase the  
vehicle speed beyond your set speed  
displays:  
1. If the set speed is exceeded by up to  
15km/h (9mph), the message centre  
will display the message along with an  
amber warning light  
Suspending ASL  
2. If the set speed is exceeded by more  
than 15km/h (9mph), the message  
centre will display the message along  
with a flashing amber warning light.  
ASL can be suspended by pressing the  
CANCEL button 3. Applying sudden,  
rapid acceleration (kickdown) will also  
suspend ASL.  
3. If the set speed is exceeded by more  
than 15km/h (9mph) for a duration of  
five seconds, the message centre will  
display the message along with a  
flashing amber warning light and also  
give an audible warning tone.  
LIMITER  
CANCELLED  
Resuming ASL  
If ASL has been suspended, it can be  
reinstated with a single press of the  
RESUME button 2, however, ASL will  
only reinstate if the vehicle speed is less  
than the current speed set in memory and  
greater than 30km/h (18mph). The  
message centre will display an  
Use your brakes to rectify the situation.  
ASL unavailable  
If ASL is not available due to a fault, the  
message centre will display an  
appropriate message along with an  
amber warning light.  
appropriate message if the vehicle speed  
is too fast to resume ASL.  
LIMITER NOT  
AVAILABLE  
TOO FAST TO  
RESUME  
The message and warning light will  
display continuously while ASL is  
selected. See Information Displays, page  
118.  
Exceeding the set speed  
If the set speed is exceeded, e.g. on a  
steep downhill section, the message  
centre will display an appropriate  
message along with an amber warning  
light.  
When the ignition is switched off, ASL is  
deactivated and any set speed is deleted  
from memory.  
OVER LIMIT  
XXX MPH  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
Audio  
JAG0282G  
FM Signals travel in a straight line, so  
RADIO RECEPTION  
large obstacles, such as tall buildings,  
can shield the car from the signal causing  
distortion or loss of reception (known as  
dead spots).  
Your radio receives signals whilst on the  
move, and may experience widely  
differing reception characteristics.  
Because of this, some interference is to  
be expected from time to time during a  
journey.  
Distortion can also occur if FM signals  
received directly from the transmitter, mix  
with signals deflected by obstructions  
such as mountains, hills, and tall  
buildings. This is known as multi-path  
distortion.  
FM transmitters can only broadcast over  
a limited range, and good clear signals  
will only be received in the immediate area  
of the transmitter. When travelling,  
occasionally it may be necessary to  
re-tune the radio to offset the effects of  
moving from one transmitter area to  
another.  
Note: Although distortion, interference  
and lack of signal clarity are sometimes  
attributed to a fault in the radio, this is  
rarely the case.  
While automatic re-tuning helps to reduce  
the effects of signal changes, some  
manual re-tuning may still be required  
(especially for local stations) in areas of  
weak reception.  
The broadcast range for good stereo  
reception is within approximately  
48 - 64 km (30 - 40 miles) of the  
transmitter.  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
Compact discs (CDs)  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
When handling CDs, do not touch the  
playing surface. CDs should be stored in  
their cases away from direct sunlight,  
heat and dust. Scratches, finger marks or  
dust on the surface of a disc can cause  
the optical pick-up to skip tracks. If the  
surface of a CD is dirty, use an  
The sound system is available in two  
versions:  
The Jaguar Sound System comprises a  
radio and in-dash 6 compact disc (CD)  
player and door mounted speakers and  
additional speakers in rear quarters.  
The Jaguar Premium Surround Sound  
System comprises a radio and in-dash 6  
compact disc (CD) player, with upgraded  
speakers mounted in the doors and rear  
quarters, plus an additional speaker  
mounted in the fascia and a sub-woofer  
mounted in the passenger foot well under  
the carpet.  
appropriate CD cleaner.  
Do not attempt to play discs that are  
damaged, warped, cracked or of  
incorrect size. They can seriously damage  
the unit’s play-back mechanism.  
Aerial operation  
Caution: When using an automatic car  
wash ensure that the audio system is  
turned OFF so that the aerial is  
retracted. Ensure that enough time is  
given for the aerial to fully retract.  
This speaker configuration allows the  
reproduction of audio in stereo, 3-channel  
or Dolby Pro Logic II Surround Sound.  
The audio system can be controlled from  
the switches on the touch-screen  
The aerial automatically rises when the  
audio system is switched ON. The aerial  
will lower when the audio system is  
switched OFF.  
console, the touch-screen buttons and  
from the multi-function controls on the  
left-hand side of the steering wheel.  
These controls are described in the  
Steering Wheel section on page 64.  
Note: The aerial will always be raised  
regardless of being in AM/FM or CD mode  
to enable RDS information (where  
available) to be received.  
Audio system care  
Caution:  
It is important to clean the aerial  
periodically to maintain smooth operation  
and good reception, see page 228.  
Care must be taken to avoid spilling  
or splashing drinks onto the audio  
unit. In the event of such an  
Caution: Do not attempt to raise the  
aerial manually.  
occurrence advise your Jaguar  
Dealer/Authorised Repairer.  
The audio unit may be damaged if  
unsuitable items like credit cards or  
coins are pushed inside the CD  
aperture.  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
AUDIO UNIT OVERVIEW  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
AM  
770  
WABC  
/
Text sent by station  
Settings  
Autostore  
WFAN  
WCBS  
WXRK  
WQXR  
WABC  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
1
WPLJ  
WHUD  
12 : 26 pm  
2
8
7
3
4
5
6
JAG0015NAS  
The Audio Unit is located in the  
Volume control: Turn the control  
knob to increase or decrease volume.  
Any volume setting made whilst in  
audio, phone, navigation or voice  
activation mode, will be memorised  
for that system.  
touch-screen console, and is controlled  
by touch-screen buttons 1 and hard  
buttons 2- 9).  
1. Touch-screen: See page 121.  
2. Load: Press to load CD, see page  
8. CD load and eject slot.  
195.  
3. Eject: Press to eject CD, see page  
195.  
4. Seek up: Press arrow to seek radio  
frequency range up or to change CD  
track up.  
5. Seek down: Press arrow to seek  
radio frequency range down or to  
change CD track down.  
6. Source: Press to change radio band  
or to change the source media  
between radio or CD.  
7. Audio system ON/OFF and volume:  
Press the control knob to switch the  
system ON/OFF.  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
USING THE AUDIO SYSTEM  
The Audio system touch-screen structure  
flow charts are referenced at page 127.  
Home  
Audio  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
To operate the audio system the ignition  
system must be ON (engine Start/Stop  
button pressed). When the engine is  
stopped, for the audio system to remain  
active, the START/STOP button must be  
pressed again without pressing the brake  
pedal.  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
71.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
JAG0285NAS  
The audio system can be turned ON in  
two ways:  
The touch-screen displays the current  
audio settings.  
Radio broadcast system display panel  
(in AM/FM mode)  
PTY  
3CH  
AM  
770  
WABC  
JAG0284G  
Pressing the audio ON/OFF control knob  
on the touch-screen console, or  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
AM  
770  
WABC  
/
Text sent by station  
Settings  
Autostore  
WFAN  
Home  
Audio  
WCBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WABC  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
WPLJ  
Climate  
Phone  
xternal  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
WHUD  
AUDIO OFF  
12 : 26 pm  
71.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
JAG0286NAS  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
JAG0283NAS  
PTY  
Priority Programme Type  
selected.  
Surround mode - Dolby Pro  
Logic II or 3CH.  
Pressing the Audio touch-screen button  
on the main Home touch-screen.  
DPL II,  
3CH  
FM2  
Frequency channel  
selected.  
89.1  
Frequency of selected  
station.  
WCBS  
Radio station selected.  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
Radio text sent by station  
3CH  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
AM  
WABC  
3
1
2
/
Text sent by station  
Settings  
Text sent by station  
Autostore  
WCBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
BC  
W
PTY  
3CH  
4
5
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
FM  
102.6  
WPLJ  
6
WNYC  
WHTZ  
WPLJ  
/
Text sent by station  
Settings  
utostore  
WFAN  
WHUD  
12 : 26 pm  
WCBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WABC  
JAG0286NAS  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
WPLJ  
1. AM/FM band switching.  
WHUD  
2. Radio text sent by radio station.  
3. Settings.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0288NAS  
4. Autostore.  
Radio text messages sent out by the  
selected station.  
5. Seek up and Seek down.  
6. Preset memorised radio stations.  
To set the display to show radio text  
messages see Settings - Options -FM  
text.  
RADIO SYSTEM OPERATION  
AM/FM band switching  
A pop-up display screen is available,  
showing the whole of the message, by  
pressing the continuation arrow.  
FM1  
FM2  
AM  
Home  
PTY  
3CH  
FM text  
Audio  
Audio  
AM  
770  
WABC  
Climate  
Phone  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Text sent by station  
Settings  
The latest news headlines from WPLG.  
Autostore  
WFAN  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
WCBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WABC  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
FM text off  
t  
WPLJ  
12 : 26 pm  
WHUD  
JAG0289NAS  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0019NAS  
The pop-up will time out after  
approximately 12 seconds, or can be  
cancelled by touching anywhere within  
the pop-up. Pressing the FM text off  
button will cancel the display for Radio  
text entirely.  
Pressing AM/FM will cycle the radio  
through FM1, FM2 and AM. Band  
selection will be shown in the display  
panel. When a CD is being played,  
pressing the band switch will select radio  
operation.  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
Settings  
Options  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
AM  
770  
WABC  
Audio  
Sound  
Settings  
FM text  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Text sent by station  
Settings  
tore  
WFAN  
Off  
On  
Options  
PTY  
WCBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WABC  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
WPLJ  
WHUD  
12 : 26 pm  
14 : 26 pm  
JAG0286NAS  
JAG0292NAS  
When selected, displays the available  
audio system setting facilities.  
Priority PTY interrupt skip: Interruptions  
for, NEWS or other selected priority PTY,  
can be skipped by pressing the skip  
button 1. This will cancel the pop-up and  
the announcement. The radio will return  
to the previously selected audio source.  
Audio  
Sound  
Settings  
Bass  
Options  
PTY  
Treble  
Balance  
Fade  
Pressing anywhere within the pop-up 2  
will cancel the pop-up but the  
announcement will continue.  
L
R
F
R
Note:  
12 : 26 pm  
Interrupt skip will not cancel activation  
of a priority PTY and it will remain  
ready for the next interrupt.  
JAG0291NAS  
Sound: Bass, Treble levels are increased  
or decreased by pressing the (+) or (-)  
buttons.  
PTY and priority PTY features are  
reliant upon the broadcast information  
from radio stations, and may be much  
better in some areas than others.  
Balance, left to right, and Fade, rear to  
front, levels are optimised for a selected  
seating position by pressing the L or R, R  
or F buttons.  
FM text is selected either ON or OFF.  
PTY (Programme type, where broadcast)  
This has two functions:  
to set a desired priority programme  
type  
to search for a programme type (PTY  
Search) and re-tune to it.  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
While PTY is displayed, a search of the  
set PTY programmes can be carried out  
by pressing the seek down or seek up  
buttons.  
Audio  
Settings  
News  
Sound  
Options  
Information  
Sports  
Talk  
Clear all  
Clear all will cancel ALL the selected  
priority settings, except for PTY-Alarm,  
and the PTY indicator will clear from the  
display,  
PTY  
Search  
PTY  
Rock  
12 : 26 pm  
PTY-Alarm (where broadcast)  
JAG0295NAS  
Use the scroll buttons to cycle through  
the available programme types (there are  
30 types available), press the required  
menu buttons to select the desired  
programme types.  
Audio  
Settings  
Personality  
Sound  
Options  
Public  
College  
Weather  
Alert  
Clear all  
PTY  
Search  
PTY  
Priority programme type  
Select the required priority programme,  
then select the previous screen button.  
The radio will now wait for RBDS  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0296NAS  
information to indicate that a station has  
changed its programme type, e.g. to  
NEWS. The radio will now re-tune to the  
new station for the duration that it remains  
on that programme type.  
When using the radio with RBDS  
selected, a PTY-Alert service may be  
activated from the menu, to alert on any  
crises of major national importance.  
When such a broadcast is made, ALERT  
will appear in the audio display. The  
default setting is ON.  
If the current station is already on the  
selected priority programme type, then  
when this station is lost, the radio will  
attempt to find another with the correct  
programme type.  
Note: PTY interrupt feature is also active  
in the CD mode.  
PTY search  
Once a desired programme type is  
selected press the PTY search button. If  
there is a station with the correct PTY,  
then the radio will re-tune to it. If not, the  
radio will indicate NO PTY and return to  
the current station.  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
Seek tuning  
Long press: In AM or FM mode, for as  
long as the button is being pressed the  
frequencies will be scanned either up or  
down.  
Seek  
The touch-screen will display manual on  
the upper display for a short time. While  
this is displayed, a short press of the  
buttons will also allow the frequencies to  
be scanned.  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
FM  
97.5  
Seek  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Settings  
Autostore  
AN  
CBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WABC  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
Autostore  
WPLJ  
PTY  
3CH  
WHUD  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
FM  
97.5  
12 : 26 pm  
/
Settings  
Autostore  
AN  
JAG0297NAS  
The seek down or seek up buttons on  
the touch-screen console and the  
touch-screen carry out the same function.  
WCBS  
WABC  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WPLJ  
WHUD  
Short press: In AM or FM mode, pressing  
and releasing the seek down (left-hand)  
or seek up (right-hand) buttons 1 will  
activate the radio tuning through the  
frequency range, up or down, to the next  
available station.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0299NAS  
Autostore: The automatic memory  
function programmes up to nine strong  
stations on a selected waveband to  
presets 1 to 9.  
The touch-screen will display Seek on the  
upper display until a station has been  
found, and will then display the station  
name, where available.  
To activate this function, press and hold  
Autostore button for at least two  
seconds.  
The radio will be briefly muted while it  
searches the selected waveband (AM,  
FM) for up to nine strong stations.  
Manual  
When programming is completed the  
radio will default to preset number 1, and  
audio volume will be restored.  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
FM  
97.5  
Manual  
/
Settings  
Autostore  
AN  
If stations cannot be located for all the  
preset positions, those that are found will  
be allocated positions commencing with  
number 1, leaving the remainder not  
programmed. The display will show ----  
and be greyed out if unprogrammed  
preset are selected.  
CBS  
WABC  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
WPLJ  
WHUD  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0298NAS  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
When programmes have been set: A  
short press of Autostore will allow the  
user to switch between the automatically  
stored stations and the manually stored  
stations.  
To activate the AVC:  
From the main Home touch-screen  
menu, select Vehicle.  
Select Syst. settings.  
Select Vol. presets.  
Preset memorised radio stations (1 - 9)  
Vehicle  
!
Display set  
WARNING:  
In the interests of road safety, do not  
attempt to preset a station while  
driving.  
Preferences  
Button audio  
Vol. presets  
Navigation  
PTY  
3CH  
AVC Low  
Medium  
High  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
FM  
93.5  
KSAN  
12 : 26 pm  
/
Settings  
Autostore  
WFAN  
JAG0301NAS  
Select either Low, Medium or High for  
WCBS  
ABC  
the AVC.  
WXRP  
WQXR  
KSAN  
WHTZ  
WPLJ  
Jaguar Premium Surround Sound  
WHUD  
This audio system has the facility of  
Digital Signal Processing (DSP) which  
optimises the sound for specific seating  
positions.  
12 : 26 pm  
KSAN  
It also allows the user to select stereo,  
3-channel stereo or Dolby Pro Logic II  
Surround Sound. It is recommended that  
Dolby Pro Logic II Surround Sound is  
used in CD mode and strong FM  
transmissions.  
JAG0300NAS  
On each waveband (AM, FM1, FM2), nine  
stations can be memorised using the  
touch-screen keypad buttons. After  
tuning to a station, press and hold the  
selected button until the station has been  
stored. A station can be recalled from the  
preset memory by pressing and  
Note:  
When various setting are altered in  
DSP, the sound will briefly fade while  
the settings are changing and will  
return to normal when the change has  
been completed.  
immediately releasing the button.  
A long press of the steering wheel preset  
selector button will cycle through the  
preset stations.  
Convertible only: The sound will  
automatically change for when the  
convertible top is up or down.  
Automatic volume control (AVC)  
This maintains radio volume at a level  
sufficient to overcome road noise as  
vehicle speed increases or decreases.  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
Settings  
These levels are altered by selecting the  
appropriate buttons.  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
AM  
770  
WABC  
Bass, Treble, Sub levels are increased or  
decreased by pressing the (+) or (-)  
buttons for the system facilities.  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Text sent by station  
Settings  
tore  
WFAN  
WCBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WABC  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
Audio  
Sound  
Settings  
DSP  
WPLJ  
Stereo  
3 Ch.  
PLII  
WHUD  
Bal/Fade  
Options  
PTY  
Base  
Treble  
Sub  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0286NAS  
Audio  
Sound  
Settings  
DSP  
Base  
12 : 26 pm  
Stereo  
3 Ch.  
LII  
JAG0307NAS  
Bal/Fade  
Options  
PTY  
To select further settings, use the scroll  
down button to access the next screen  
display.  
Treble  
Sub  
Audio  
Sound  
Settings  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0303NAS  
Bal/Fade  
Options  
PTY  
Center  
When selected, defaults to Sound and  
displays the available premium audio  
system setting facilities.  
Surround  
Audio  
Sound  
Settings  
DSP  
12 : 26 pm  
Stereo  
3 Ch.  
PLII  
JAG0308NAS  
Bal/Fade  
Options  
PTY  
1
2
3
Select either Centre or Surround.  
Treble  
Sub  
Note: The number of available settings  
will depend on whether Stereo, 3Ch or  
Dolby Pro Logic II Surround Sound is  
selected.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0306NAS  
Stereo, 1  
3 Ch, 2  
Dolby Pro Logic II Surround Sound,  
3.  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
Options and PTY functions are the same  
as for the Jaguar Sound System, refer to  
Settings on page 187.  
Audio  
Sound  
Settings  
DSP  
Stereo  
3 Ch.  
PLII  
Bal/Fade  
Options  
PTY  
Base  
Treble  
Sub  
RADIO BROADCAST DATA  
SYSTEM (RBDS)  
Your radio is equipped with RBDS, which  
enables the audio unit to receive  
additional information with normal radio  
signals.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0304NAS  
When tuned to certain stations on the FM  
waveband the radio decodes signals  
transmitted to provide the following  
functions (dependent upon the service  
available from the broadcasters).  
DSP (Digital Signal Processing): To  
optimise the sound for specific seating  
positions select DSP and then select the  
required seating position.  
Note: Not all FM radio stations broadcast  
RBDS. If a non-RBDS station is received,  
RBDS features will not be available.  
Audio  
DSP  
Settings  
Front  
Driver  
All  
RBDS station name display:  
When RBDS is selected the station  
name is displayed.  
RDS Priority programme type auto  
re-tuning (where broadcast):  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0305NAS  
Can be selected to interrupt and  
switch to the selected programme  
type e.g. News, for its duration or can  
be used to search for specific PTY  
stations.  
Either Front, Driver or All may be  
selected.  
Audio  
Sound  
Settings  
If the RBDS function does not respond  
correctly, see the trouble-shooting guide  
on the next page.  
Bal/Fade  
Options  
PTY  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0309NAS  
Bal/Fade: The sound can be optimised  
by using the scrolling buttons to alter the  
Balance (left to right) and Fade (front to  
rear).  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
RBDS trouble-shooting guide  
Incorrect response from RBDS  
Reason and rectification  
Radio does not display programme RBDS name is not available from the broadcast.  
name.  
Station name is lost and displays  
frequency only.  
Radio has lost reception of the RBDS data due  
to vehicle moving out of transmitter range, loss  
of signal in a tunnel, under a garage forecourt  
canopy, or similar screening. If the latter is the  
case, when the vehicle is clear of the screening,  
the station name will return after a short delay.  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
An in-dash 6 compact disc (CD) player is  
COMPACT DISC (CD) SYSTEM  
OPERATION  
Caution:  
installed in the touch-screen console, see  
page 184, and it will accommodate up to  
six discs. It will play Compact Disc Digital  
Audio (CDDA) discs (normal discs), MP3  
and WMA files.  
Copyright laws vary in different  
countries; check the laws in your  
country if you want to record from  
copyright source material.  
Home  
Audio  
Due to technical incompatibility,  
recordable (CD-R) discs and  
re-writable (CD-RW) discs may not  
function correctly.  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
CD  
Tr  
03:42  
62  
Right  
F
3
71.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
These CD units will play compact  
discs that conform to the  
international Red Book standard  
audiospecification. Copyprotected  
CDs from some manufacturers do  
not conform to this standard and  
playback cannot be guaranteed.  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
JAG0310NAS  
The main Home screen display will  
indicate which CD slot is loaded and  
ready for playing. If no CDs have been  
loaded, the touch-screen indicates the  
unloaded state by displaying the six  
ghosted discs.  
Dual format, dual sided discs (DVD  
Plus, CD-DVD format), now being  
adopted by the music industry, are  
thicker than normal CDs and  
consequently playback cannot be  
guaranteed in Jaguar audio units,  
and jamming could occur. Warranty  
claims, where this type of disc is  
found to be inside an audio unit  
returned for repair, will not be  
accepted.  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
AM FM  
CD  
AM  
770  
WABC  
/
Text sent by station  
Settings  
Autostore  
WFAN  
WCBS  
WXRP  
WQXR  
WABC  
WNYC  
WHTZ  
WPLJ  
WHUD  
Irregular shaped CDs and CDs with  
a scratch protection film or self  
adhesive labels attached should  
not be used.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0311NAS  
To access the CD player touch-screen:  
Note: Some privately recorded CD-R  
discs may not have been acceptably  
formatted to be able to be played on this  
CD player.  
From the main Home touch-screen  
menu, select Audio.  
Select CD.  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
To load the CD player  
More than one CD:  
Single CD - player empty:  
JAG0314G  
JAG0312G  
Press the LOAD button and insert each  
CD into an CD slot as requested by the  
displayed message. A pop-up message  
on the screen will indicate which slot is  
being selected until the unit is fully  
loaded.  
Load a CD into the loading slot. A CD  
loading message is displayed on the  
touch-screen.  
Single CD - player partially loaded:  
When the CD player has been loaded, CD  
operation is via the CD touch-screen.  
Audio  
Tr 1  
00:00  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Settings  
To unload the CD player  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Mix  
Repeat  
12 : 26 pm  
1
2
3
JAG0313NAS  
From the CD player touch-screen, select  
an empty slot 2, 1 indicates the current  
playing CD, 3 indicates loaded slots. A  
message indicates to insert the CD into  
the empty slot. Load a CD into the slot.  
JAG0315G  
Press the eject button. A short press will  
eject a single CD, a long press will eject  
each loaded CD in turn.  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
CD Touch-screen display and  
operation  
03:47 - Track elapsed time play.  
Seek down and seek up buttons:  
Short press: Seeks down to previous  
track or up to next track.  
3CH  
Tr  
Loading CD 1  
Long press: Press the seek down to  
play rapidly back through one or more  
tracks (review). Press the seek up to  
play rapidly forward through one or  
more tracks (cue). Normal playback  
will resume when either button is  
released.  
3CH  
Audio  
Tr  
Loading CD 1  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Settings  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Mix  
Repeat  
Mix CD  
Mix all  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0316NAS  
3CH  
Audio  
Tr 12  
Mix CD  
03 47  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Settings  
DPLII Surround mode - Dolby Pro  
or  
Logic II selected or 3-channel.  
3CH  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Mix  
Repeat  
When a CD has been selected, the upper  
display indicates which disc is being  
loaded and will commence playing when  
loading has been completed.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0319NAS  
II - Pause button; Will pause the playing  
track until pressed again. To resume the  
CD, press again.  
Tr 12  
03 47  
Mix CD: Short press: The track order of  
play from the current CD is randomly  
selected by the CD player, (on MP3 CDs a  
short press will mix the tracks from the  
current folder).  
3CH  
Audio  
Tr 12  
03 47  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Settings  
2
3
4
6
Mix all: Long press: The CD order of play  
is randomly selected, by the CD player,  
from all the loaded CDs, (on MP3 CDs a  
long press will mix the tracks from all the  
folders of the current MP3 disc).  
Mix  
Repeat  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0318NAS  
Note: If the volume is turned down to  
zero, the CD is automatically paused. Play  
is resumed when the volume is increased.  
TR12 - Track number display of the track  
being played.  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
Audio  
Settings  
Rpt Tr  
Rpt CD  
CD text Off  
On  
Sound  
Options  
PTY  
3CH  
Audio  
Tr 12  
Mix CD  
03 47  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Settings  
1
2
3
4
5
6
14 : 26 pm  
Mix  
Repeat  
JAG0322NAS  
Options: CD text can be selected in the  
CD mode.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0320NAS  
The CD text display is similar to the Radio  
text, but displays text that has been  
recorded onto the CD (not all CDs have  
CD text).  
Repeat:  
Short press: Rpt Tr: Will repeat the  
playing of the track continuously until  
repeat is cancelled by pressing again.  
COMPACT DISC -  
RECORDABLE (CD-R)  
Some pre-recorded and personally  
recorded discs, can contain additional  
information on the disc, e.g. CD titles,  
track titles and the artists name (ID 3  
Tags).  
Long press: Rpt CD: Will repeat the  
playing of the whole CD continuously  
until repeat is cancelled by pressing  
again.  
Settings  
3CH  
Additional buttons allow you to select  
folders and tracks and display various  
items of information about the recordings.  
Typically, MP3 discs have the potential to  
hold a great deal more music than a  
conventional CD because each track can  
be compressed to a higher degree during  
recording.  
Audio  
Tr 12  
Mix CD  
03 47  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Settings  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Mix  
Repeat  
12 : 26 pm  
If you record your own music, each  
JAG0321NAS  
session must be properly closed, but the  
whole disc does not have to be finalised.  
When selected, displays the available CD  
system setting facilities similar to the  
audio system, see pages 187 and 191.  
Note:  
A mixture of CDs and MP3 discs can  
be loaded into the CD player together.  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio  
The CD player is not guaranteed to  
play every disc available because of  
variations in the quality of discs.  
3CH  
Audio  
Tr 2  
CD 3  
00 00  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Revolver  
Playing MP3 discs  
Taxman  
Eleanor Rigby  
I'm Only Sleepin
Love You To  
3CH  
Audio  
Tr  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Settings  
Folders  
12 : 26 pm  
1
2
3
6
JAG0325NAS  
Mix  
Repeat  
Select the folder to access the tracks  
contained within the folder.  
12 : 26 pm  
MP3 folder and track format  
JAG0323NAS  
A CD-R or CD-RW can have MP3 folders  
and tracks recorded in many different  
ways, with many layers of folders and with  
tracks distributed throughout the folder  
structure.  
If the MP3 disc has been recorded with  
the music files contained within folders,  
additional information is available by  
selecting Folders.  
To minimise the loading on the system, a  
rigid folder structure is recommended.  
3CH  
Audio  
Tr  
CD 3  
00 00  
AM  
CD  
/
FM  
Beatles-Hits  
Note:  
Help  
Any CD containing a mixture of MP3  
and CDDA tracks will be treated as a  
CD (any MP3 tracks will be ignored).  
Please Please Me  
Revolver  
The CD player may take a long time  
(one minute or more) to load an MP3  
disc owing to the number of tracks on  
it.  
Sgt. Pep
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0324NAS  
The titles of any tracks and folders  
recorded on the CD will be displayed in  
alphabetical order as the disc may be  
recorded in another order.  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
Satellite Radio  
RECEIVING SATELLITE RADIO  
BROADCASTS  
To access satellite radio from the vehicle  
Home screen:  
TM  
Welcome to Jaguar Touch Drive  
Audio  
Sat Radio  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Ch021 Octane  
Rock  
71.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
12 : 34 pm  
Valet  
JOL4458  
Select Audio on the touch-screen.  
Audio  
SR1 CH022 Octane  
Rock Hits  
AM/FM  
Settings  
Sat Options  
1053  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Octane  
Bridge  
I-90  
Pulse  
Nation  
SATELLITE DIGITAL AUDIO  
RADIO SERVICE (SDARS)  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
Signals from a satellite broadcast radio  
service are encoded and a subscription to  
the broadcast operator (SIRIUS) is  
required to receive them.  
JOL4673  
Select Sat Radio.  
If you are not currently subscribed to  
SIRIUS, No Subscription will be  
displayed below Sat Radio followed by a  
subscription screen, see page 209.  
The following features are inhibited when  
driving:  
Parental lock.  
Channel skip.  
Edit favourites - song seek list.  
As a digital signal is used, satellite radio is  
able to provide output of radio broadcasts  
with the sound quality and clarity of CD  
playback.  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
Satellite radio display panel  
Preset memorised radio channels  
Three screens are available, listed as  
SR1, SR2 and SR3, each displayed on the  
top line of the screen. Each screen can  
display up to six preset channels, giving a  
total of 18 possible preset channels.  
Audio  
SR1 CH022 Octane  
Rock Hits  
AM/FM  
Settings  
Sat Options  
1053  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Selecting Sat Radio repeatedly, cycles  
through the three screens.  
Octane  
Bridge  
I-90  
Pulse  
Nation  
Guns & Roses  
SR1  
SR2  
SR3  
12 : 34 pm  
Audio  
SR2 Ch101 Vista  
Dance  
JOL4512  
AM/FM  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Settings  
Sat Options  
CNBC  
1. Category of music which is currently  
selected.  
Octane  
Strobe  
Wax  
2. Channel which is currently selected.  
3. Seek up and seek down buttons.  
4. Back - to previous screen or setting.  
The Pulse Disney  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4461  
5. Programme description text (PDT)  
description, which provides details  
(where available) of the artist’s name,  
song title and the composer and  
subscription information.  
Preset memorised channel - setting  
To save a channel as a preset, tune into  
the channel that is to be stored, then  
press and hold the desired preset button  
for approximately two seconds. Audio  
output is muted while the channel is being  
stored and returns once the operation is  
complete.  
6. PDT text display area - artist currently  
playing.  
7. Six preset memorised radio channels.  
Press to select the required channel  
e.g. Octane preset is selected in the  
above example.  
To change a preset, select the desired  
channel either via Category lists, see  
page 204 or manually, Direct channel  
entry, see page 205. Then press and hold  
the desired preset until the new channel is  
stored.  
Note: If manual tuning is used and a  
channel is selected that is an existing  
preset, the preset will highlight. If the  
same channel is stored in more than one  
preset (on different screens for example)  
and manual tuning is performed, the first  
preset will highlight.  
If required, repeat the procedure to store  
up to 17 other satellite channels.  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
Recalling a preset channel  
SONG SEEK  
Song Seek can store up to 10 song titles  
along with the artist’s name etc., if it is  
transmitted with the PDT (Programme  
Descriptive Text) information.  
SR1  
Octane  
Audio  
SR1 CH022 Octane  
Rock Hits  
AM/FM  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Settings  
Sat Options  
1053  
If, while listening to any satellite channel,  
one of the stored Song Seek Favourites is  
playing on any other satellite channel, the  
user will be alerted visually. The user can  
choose to tune to that channel.  
Octane  
Bridge  
I-90  
Pulse  
Nation  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4460  
Audio  
SR1 Ch042 Hot Jamz  
R&B/ Urban  
AM/FM  
Settings  
Select the appropriate source where the  
desired channel is located (SR1, SR2 or  
SR3) by pressing Sat Radio to cycle  
through the list.  
SongSeek Interrupt  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Guns & Roses  
The Rock.....  
Switch to Channel 021?  
Yes  
No  
Select the desired preset button, e.g.  
Octane. Audio output will switch to the  
satellite channel stored on the selected  
preset.  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4493  
The display indicates that the user is  
currently listening to Ch042 (Channel 42  
Hot Jamz on SR1).  
Seek Up and Seek Down  
Audio  
SR1 22 Octa
The Song Seek pop-up (Song Seek  
Interrupt) is giving the user the choice to  
listen instead, to a Favourites (Guns &  
Roses) which is currently playing on  
Channel 021.  
Roc1
2
AM/FM  
Settings  
Sat Options  
1053  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Octane  
Bridge  
I-90  
Pulse  
Nation  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4513  
Short press: Either the seek down button  
(1) or seek up button (2) to step to the next  
numerical channel.  
The channel which is displayed on release  
of either button will be the channel that  
satellite radio will tune to.  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
Activating song seek  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Rock  
Audio  
SR1 CH022 Octane  
AM/FM  
Settings  
SAT Information  
AM/FM  
Rock Hits  
Settings  
Sat Radio  
Guns & Roses  
The Rock  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Sat Options  
1053  
CD  
Add to Favorites  
Edit Favorites  
Octane  
Bridge  
I-90  
Pulse  
Nation  
Guns & Roses  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4490  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4514  
If Song Seek is not active, then both Add  
to Favourites and Edit Favourites will be  
inoperative.  
To activate Song Seek, select Settings  
and then select Song Seek.  
When the feature is active, pressing the  
PDT button on the Settings display  
screen, will present the user with the  
Satellite Information display pop-up  
where the current favourite songs can be  
viewed and edited.  
If Edit Favourites is selected, then the  
following screen will be displayed.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Pink Floyd  
Breathe  
Beatles  
Revolver  
Delete  
When the feature is not active, the user  
cannot add to or edit the favourite songs  
list. However, the PDT information can  
still be seen by selecting the PDT button.  
Delete All  
Guns & Roses  
Beatles  
Paradise City  
Eleanor Rigby  
My Generation  
The Who  
12 : 34 pm  
Editing song seek favourites list  
JOL4496  
Note: Editing of the favourites list cannot  
be carried out while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
Delete All is highlighted and if selected,  
all songs in the Song Seek favourites list  
will be deleted.  
To edit the list of songs in Song Seek,  
select Edit Favourites on the SAT  
Information pop-up.  
Should only one song at a time be  
required to be deleted, select the  
particular song on the list.  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
If the user adds the song to the favourites  
list, confirmation is as follows:  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Pink Floyd  
Breathe  
Audio  
SR1 Ch040 Wax  
Pop  
Beatles  
Revolver  
Delete  
AM/FM  
Settings  
SAT Information  
Delete All  
Guns & Roses  
Beatles  
Paradise City  
Eleanor Rigby  
My Generation  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Entry Added  
The Who  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4495  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
Select Delete to delete that song only.  
Repeat the procedure for each song to be  
deleted.  
JOL4491  
Favourites list is full  
In all cases the user will be asked to  
confirm that the song or songs should be  
deleted.  
If the favourites list is full, the SAT  
Information pop-up will indicate Entry  
List is full. Delete Entry?  
Adding a song to the favourites list  
One or more songs must be deleted  
before another song can be entered.  
To add a song to the Song Seek  
favourites list, the following is necessary:  
All songs may be deleted if desired.  
The song should be currently playing.  
The user must select the PDT button;  
a right-hand facing arrow situated at  
the lower right hand side of the  
screens.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch101 Vista  
Pop  
AM/FM  
Settings  
SAT Information  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Guns & Roses  
The Rock  
The following screen will provide the  
details of the song and give the user the  
choice to add it to the favourites list.  
Add to Favorites  
Edit Favorites  
i
Entry List is full. Delete Entry  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4494  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Rock  
AM/FM  
Settings  
To be able to put the Guns & Roses  
example into the song seek favourites list,  
first Edit Favourites in order to make  
space.  
SAT Information  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Guns & Roses  
The Rock  
Add to Favorites  
Edit Favorites  
Guns & Roses  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4492  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
The following screen shows some of the  
various channels that play music within  
the Pop category.  
SAT OPTIONS MENU  
The Sat Options button on the satellite  
radio screen provides four other menu  
features plus a SAT information screen.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch040 Wax  
Pop  
AM/FM  
Settings  
Sat Options  
CNBC  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Rock  
Sat Radio  
CD  
AM/FM  
Settings  
Sat Options  
CNBC  
Octane  
Strobe  
Wax  
The Pulse  
Sat Radio  
CD  
---  
Octane  
Strobe  
Wax  
Bill Withers - Lovely Day  
The Pulse  
---  
12 : 34 pm  
Culture Club  
JOL4469  
12 : 34 pm  
Once a channel within the Pop Category  
(or any other category) has been selected,  
the radio will re-tune to that channel and  
the display will return to the Sat Radio  
Home screen, but with the new channel  
information displayed.  
JOL4466  
Select Sat Options to view the available  
options.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
All Channels  
The new channel is Ch040 Wax, whereas  
the previous channel was Ch021 Octane.  
Category Lists  
Settings  
Direct Channel  
Parental Lock  
Channel Skip  
Pop  
Browse PDT  
Rock  
The Browse feature allows the user to  
scan all available PDT (Programme  
Descriptive Text) within a given category  
without changing the current satellite  
channel.  
R&B / Urban  
SAT Information  
Dance  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4467  
The options are:  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
040 Wax  
Category Lists.  
Direct Channel.  
Parental Lock.  
Channel Skip.  
SAT Information.  
041 Sirius Hits  
042 Slow Jamz  
043 The Express  
044 The Vault  
Browse PDT  
Category lists  
12 : 34 pm  
The above screen shows that Category  
Lists has already been selected and that  
the Pop category has also been selected.  
JOL4468  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
The Browse feature will update the PDT  
information as programme information  
changes within the SIRIUS broadcast.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
105  
Category Lists  
C
Direct Channel  
Parental Lock  
Channel Skip  
Sat Information  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Pink Floyd  
Beatles  
Breathe  
001  
002  
003  
004  
Revolver  
0
OK  
Guns & Roses  
Beatles  
Paradise City  
Eleanor Rigby  
My Generation  
12 : 26 pm  
JOL4474  
The Who  
005  
Channel number 105 has been entered.  
12 : 34 pm  
A short press on the C (Clear) button will  
JOL4470  
delete one digit at a time.  
This view can be maintained while  
listening to the audio on the current  
satellite channel. The user can scroll  
across all available channels using the up  
and down arrows to view broadcasted  
PDT information. At any time a new  
channel can be selected and the screen  
will return to the normal satellite view.  
Select OK when the desired channel  
number has been entered correctly.  
If an invalid channel number has been  
entered, this will be displayed on the  
screen.  
If a valid channel has been entered, then  
the following screen (Sat Radio Home  
screen) will be displayed, but with the new  
channel information.  
Direct channel entry  
This option allows the user to input the  
channel number directly.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch105 Bloomberg  
News  
Select Sat Options on the satellite radio  
Home screen.  
AM/FM  
tings  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Sat Options  
Octane  
Strobe  
Wax  
CNBC  
---  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
The Pulse  
Category L
Enter Channel Number  
C
Todays Stock Report  
Direct Channel  
Parental Lock  
Channel Skip  
Sat Information  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4475  
0
OK  
Parental lock  
12 : 26 pm  
This option allows the user to lock any  
given channel or channels to prevent  
them from being accessed.  
JOL4473  
Select Direct Channel on the Sat  
Options screen, and a numerical keypad  
will be displayed. The user is asked to  
enter a channel number.  
The locked channels will be skipped when  
navigating through the channels using the  
seek up or seek down buttons.  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
To set-up, select Sat Options on the  
satellite radio screen.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
040 Wax  
Note: Parental Lock cannot be performed  
while the vehicle is in motion.  
041 Sirius Hits  
042 Slow Jamz  
043 The Express  
044 The Vault  
Unlock All  
Lock All  
Edit PIN  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Enter PIN  
Category Lists  
C
Direct Channel  
Parental Lock  
Channel
Sat Information  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4478  
Two channels are shown with the Lock  
symbol.  
0
OK  
12 : 26 pm  
There are three keys that the user can use  
to lock or unlock channels.  
JOL4476  
Select Parental Lock on the Sat Options  
screen, and a numerical keypad will be  
displayed. Enter a PIN number.  
The user can lock or unlock an individual  
channel or lock them all within a  
Category. To lock an individual channel,  
just select the desired channel and select  
Lock or Lock All depending on what is  
displayed. The unlock procedure is the  
same.  
Number entry is identical to that for Direct  
Channel Selection, except that there must  
be four digits e.g. 125 must be entered as  
0125 etc.  
If the correct PIN is entered the following  
screen is displayed which shows the  
different Categories and All Channels.  
Edit Personal Identification Number  
(PIN)  
To edit the parental lock PIN, the user  
must first enter the existing PIN.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
If the system confirms that the entered  
PIN is the correct one it will respond with  
PIN Verified - Enter New PIN.  
All Channels  
Pop  
Rock  
Enter the desired PIN (four digits).  
R&B / Urban  
Dance  
This new PIN will then be stored and  
over-write the previous one. A SAT  
Information pop-up will indicate New PIN  
Accepted.  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4477  
Viewing a locked channel  
Pop category has been selected.  
When a locked channel is selected by  
Channel Navigation, Direct Channel Entry  
or Search by Category, it will not play and  
will give the message Channel Locked  
Enter PIN.  
After selecting Pop, the following screen  
will be displayed:  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
Enter the PIN via the keypad which will  
subsequently be displayed.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch172 Intimate  
If the correct PIN is entered, the channel  
will play. However, the channel will play  
only for the current driving cycle and will  
again be locked the next time that the  
vehicle is started and used.  
AM/FM  
User PIN Has been Reset  
C
Sat Radio  
CD  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
0
OK  
If the PIN that is entered is incorrect, the  
message Entry Invalid - Please try again  
will be displayed.  
12 : 26 pm  
JOL4668  
Lost PIN information  
The PIN will have been reset to the system  
default of 1111.  
If the user loses or forgets the PIN, access  
may still be gained and a new PIN  
entered, as follows.  
Go to Edit PIN and enter a new number.  
Channel Skip  
Select Sat Options on the satellite radio  
screen, to display the Options screen:  
Channel Skip can be used to hide  
channels from being selected when using  
the seek up and seek down buttons - the  
channels are actually skipped, not  
hidden.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Enter PIN  
Category Lists  
C
Select Sat Options on the satellite radio  
screen, to display the Options screen:  
Direct Channel  
Parental Lock  
Channel Skip  
Sat Information  
1
2
5
8
3
6
9
1
7
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
All Channels  
0
OK  
Category Lists  
2
12 : 26 pm  
Direct Channel  
Parental Lock  
Channel Skip  
Pop  
2
JOL4674  
Rock  
Select Parental Lock 1 on the Sat  
Options screen, and hold for 10  
seconds - then release.  
R&B / Urban  
1
SAT Information  
Dance  
12 : 34 pm  
Select SAT Information 2 and hold  
for 10 seconds - then release.  
JOL4479  
Select Channel Skip 1 on the Sat  
Options screen and the Category List will  
be displayed.  
After a time-out period, the system  
will display User PIN Has Been  
Reset.  
Select the Category in which to view the  
channels e.g. Pop 2.  
When Pop has been selected the  
channels within that category will be  
displayed.  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
Select SAT Information on the Sat  
Options screen. This information is  
displayed automatically when the system  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
040 Wax  
is asking the user to subscribe to SIRIUS.  
041 Sirius Hits  
042 Slow Jamz  
043 The Express  
044 The Vault  
Unskip All  
Skip All  
SUBSCRIPTION TO SIRIUS  
When Sat Radio has been selected, but a  
subscription to the provider has not been  
made, a message will appear, showing  
the telephone number of the provider.  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4480  
Individual channels within a category can  
be Skipped by selecting a channel and  
pressing Skip.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
AM/FM  
All channels within a category can be  
Skipped by pressing Skip All or  
unskipped by pressing Unskip All.  
Sat Radio  
CD  
Sirius Satellite Radio Inc.  
For Subscription Information Call:  
888 - 539 - SIRIUS  
Your SIRIUS ID: 012345678910  
Hidden (skipped) channels are accessible  
by Direct Channel Entry.  
Note: If same channel is locked and  
skipped, then when the channel is  
unlocked it will become unskipped.  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4464  
Also shown is the SIRIUS ID that  
identifies the receiver unit and is linked to  
the VIN of the vehicle.  
SAT Information  
The SAT Information screen contains the  
SIRIUS contact telephone number and  
the satellite radio Identification Number.  
To subscribe, call the number indicated  
and quote the SIRIUS ID, this would  
normally be done by your Jaguar Dealer.  
Select Sat Options on the satellite radio  
screen, to display the Options screen.  
If SIRIUS has not yet been subscribed to,  
the system will tune to the preview  
channel - currently number 184. This  
channel is accessible for a limited period  
only, for approximately 90 days after  
purchase of the vehicle.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch021 Octane  
Category Lists  
Sirius Satellite Radio Inc.  
Direct Channel  
Parental Lock  
Channel Skip  
For Subscription Information Call:  
888 - 539 - SIRIUS  
The ignition system must be ON and the  
vehicle must be outdoors in plain view of  
the sky whilst authorisation takes place.  
This authorisation/activation can take up  
to 15 minutes.  
Your SIRIUS ID: 012345678910  
SAT Information  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4481  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Satellite Radio  
Unsubscribed radio channels  
After the automatic update procedure, the  
following should be noted:  
If a channel is selected for which there is  
no valid subscription, Unsubscribed  
Channel is displayed.  
1. All locked channels will be unlocked.  
2. All skipped channels will be  
Either subscribe to this selected channel  
or select an alternative channel that has  
already been subscribed to.  
unskipped.  
Signal acquiring  
If the satellite signal is lost, or not found,  
Acquiring will be shown on the display.  
Audio  
SR1 Ch150 Disney  
AM/FM  
Unsubscribed Channel  
Settings  
Sat Options  
CNBC  
Audio  
SR2 Acquiring........  
Rock  
Sat Radio  
CD  
AM/FM  
Settings  
Sat Options  
CNBC  
Octane  
Strobe  
Wax  
Sat Radio  
CD  
The Pulse  
---  
Octane  
---  
Wax  
Call SIRIUS to Subscribe  
The Pulse  
Spirit  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4465  
12 : 34 pm  
At the bottom of the screen Call SIRIUS  
to Subscribe is displayed. Select the  
right arrow button to display the  
JOL4482  
If the signal is not regained within a few  
seconds, all of the relevant soft buttons  
will inhibited. The dotted line after  
Acquiring will flash until the channel is  
regained.  
Subscription Details Pop-up screen.  
Automatic updates of channels  
Occasionally the system will be updated  
automatically by SIRIUS.  
When the signal has been regained, the  
selected channel will again play.  
Audio  
Note: This is NOT the same as No  
Subscription. The system is only  
informing the driver that it cannot find the  
signal, perhaps because of very tall  
buildings or the vehicle is in a long tunnel.  
AM/FM  
Sirius Update  
Please Wait  
Sat Radio  
CD  
60%  
12 : 34 pm  
JOL4483  
Whilst updating, the audio will be muted.  
When updating has been completed the  
update screen details cancel.  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Telephone  
Whilst in a phone call, the  
phone uses its own antenna  
to communicate to the  
WHAT IS BLUETOOTH?  
!
WARNING:  
cellar network and therefore the  
phone reception is controlled by the  
cell telephone itself.  
Using any hand-held appliance  
while driving can be dangerous and  
is illegal in certain countries.  
The vehicle’s Bluetooth telephone system  
can be used with an appropriate,  
Bluetooth-equipped cell phone.  
Always stop the vehicle before  
making a call and ensure that the  
telephone is switched off while you  
are driving.  
Please refer to your Jaguar Dealer for a list  
of compatible phones.  
Bluetooth is an international standard that  
allows electronic devices to communicate  
with each other using a short-range radio  
link. Bluetooth eliminates the need for  
wires or cables. Typically, devices can  
communicate at a range of up to 10  
metres (33 feet).  
The cell phone must be paired and  
docked with the vehicle system before  
use, see SETTING UP YOUR PHONE on  
page -211. Once paired and docked, the  
phone can be operated via the steering  
wheel switches, the cell phone or the  
touch-screen.  
The Bluetooth in-car telephone system  
allows certain cell phones to be used  
hands free in your vehicle. There is no  
need to connect the cell phone to a cradle  
or cable.  
The cell phone doesn’t need to be  
physically connected to the vehicle, it can  
be left in a jacket pocket, for instance.  
Calls are routed through the vehicle’s  
audio speakers, and a dedicated  
microphone is fitted behind the A post  
trim on the drivers side.  
Bluetooth is a registered trademark of  
Bluetooth SIG, Inc.  
You can use the system to answer or  
reject incoming calls, make outgoing calls  
or alter the call volume. The system does  
not support SMS text messaging.  
SYSTEM OVERVIEW  
Note:  
The vehicle ignition system must be  
ON and the touch-screen system  
must be active in order to use the  
phone.  
Call volume  
The volume of the telephone call can be  
adjusted for hands-free operation. To  
adjust the volume, operate the audio  
system’s volume control during a phone  
call, see page 184.  
If your cellphone battery  
charge becomes low it may  
switch off its Bluetooth link  
to the vehicle. This is normal for cell  
telephones to help preserve remaining  
battery charge. In this event, the  
vehicle touch-screen will display a  
Phone connection message.  
If the audio system is in use when the  
phone becomes active, the audio system  
source is suppressed for the duration of  
the call.  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
The Jaguar telephone system is designed  
3. From the home menu screen select  
Phone.  
to function with a variety of Bluetooth  
equipped cell phones. The audio and  
echo characteristics vary between  
models of cell phones, as a result, it may  
take a few seconds for the vehicle system  
to adapt to provide optimal audio  
performance.  
Home  
Audio  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
1.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
In order to achieve the best possible  
audio performance, it may be necessary  
to reduce the system volume slightly  
when using certain cell phones.  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
Phone  
SETTING UP YOUR PHONE  
Register  
Docked phone: None  
Telephone pairing and docking  
Voice mail  
Before use, your cell phone must be  
connected or paired and docked with the  
vehicle’s Bluetooth system.  
Answer options  
Nametags  
Undock  
Other options  
Note: Pairing is the process that uses a  
secure communication channel to allow  
two Bluetooth devices to recognise each  
other e.g. the vehicle and the cell phone.  
Phone options Ch  
ange phone  
Search new  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0326NAS  
4. If this is the first time that a phone has  
been paired to the vehicle select  
Search new. The system will search  
for all Bluetooth phones that are in  
range. If a phone is already docked it  
will be automatically undocked when  
a search is initiated.  
Docking means that a phone has been  
paired, recognised, and now requires to  
be connected to the vehicle  
Follow these steps to pair/dock your  
phone:  
1. Switch on your cell phone’s Bluetooth  
connection, using the phone’s menu.  
Make sure that your cell phone is in  
Bluetooth discoverable mode,  
sometimes referred to as find me  
mode. (See your phone’s manual for  
more information.)  
Phone  
Digit Dial  
Names  
Bluetooth search  
Please wait . .  
Searching . . .  
Cancel  
Last 10  
2. Switch the vehicle’s ignition system  
ON, ensure that the touch-screen  
system is active.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0328NAS  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Note: Ensure that the Timeout to  
Enter this into your phone (see your  
phone’s handbook for more  
information).  
home screen is turned Off before  
starting a search sequence, see page  
126.  
Phone  
5. If a phone has previously been paired  
to the vehicle select Phone then  
Settings.  
Not  
Paired  
Vertu Ascent  
Nokia 623  
Pair & dock  
Delete  
Phone  
To pair & dock phone  
Enter (5616) on handset  
Home  
Audio  
Cancel  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0330NAS  
1.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
8. Your phone is now paired and docked  
ready for use, see Making a Call on  
page -217, see Ending a Call on  
page -217 and see Receiving a call  
on page -218.  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
Phone  
Note:  
Digit Dial  
Settings  
Once a cell phone has been paired  
and docked with the vehicle, the  
system will search for the last  
connected phone each time the  
ignition is switched ON. You do not  
need to manually pair and dock the  
phone with the vehicle every time you  
switch the ignition ON.  
Names  
Last 10  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
Options  
C
*
0
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0327NAS  
6. Select your phone from displayed list.  
If an incorrect code is entered, your  
cell phone should prompt you to enter  
the correct code.  
7. Once you have selected your phone a  
pop-up window appears.  
When the vehicle's entertainment  
system is active and the last  
connected phone comes into range of  
the vehicle, the system will attempt to  
connect to it.  
To pair and dock phone enter XXXX  
on the handset, XXXX being a random  
four digit code displayed on the touch  
screen.  
If a phone call is ongoing when the  
phone is connected, the phone call  
will be automatically transferred to the  
vehicle's microphone and speakers.  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
If you wish to avoid this occurring  
ensure that Bluetooth is turned off at  
the phone.  
Phone  
Register  
Docked phone: Motorola Pho....  
Pairing other phones  
Voice mail  
Up to five cell phones can be paired with  
the vehicle in the same way, however only  
one can be docked for use. For further  
information, see SETTING UP YOUR  
PHONE on page -211, see Changing or  
deleting the phone on page -213.  
Answer options  
Undock  
Other options  
Phone options Ch  
ange phone  
Search new  
12 : 26 pm  
Phone  
Changing or deleting the phone  
Motorola Pho.....  
Delete  
Delete  
Delete  
Docked  
Paired  
Only one phone can be docked to the  
vehicle at any one time. To dock a  
different paired phone to the vehicle,  
follow these steps:  
Nokia 6230  
Dock  
Dock  
Paired  
Vertu Ascent  
1
2
Home  
Audio  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0331NAS  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
1. Select Dock from the list of available  
phones.  
1.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
2. Selecting Delete permanently  
removes the phone from the list. To  
use the phone again you have to pair  
and dock the phone to the vehicle,  
see SETTING UP YOUR PHONE on  
page -211.  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
Phone  
Digit Dial  
Settings  
Note: The phone does not need to be  
present to be deleted from the list.  
Names  
Last 10  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
Options  
C
*
0
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0327NAS  
From the home menu screen select  
Phone, then Settings then Change  
phone.  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Select Voice mail enter the number  
SETTINGS MENUS  
provided by your service provider and  
press OK. This number is stored in the  
system and used to retrieve any voice  
mail messages.  
Register  
From the settings main menu selecting  
Register gives the options to Undock,  
Change phone or Search new, for  
further information,see SETTING UP  
YOUR PHONE on page -211 see Pairing  
other phones on page -213 or see  
Changing or deleting the phone on  
page -213.  
Retrieving voice mail  
Phone  
Digit Dial  
Names  
Settings  
Options  
1
4
7
2
8
3
6
9
Last 10  
Voice mail  
You can set up your voice mail to be  
accessed via the touch-screen. The voice  
mail (network service) option is an  
answering service where callers who are  
unable to reach you can leave you  
messages.  
C
*
0
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0334NAS  
To listen to your voice mail messages  
press and hold 1.  
The voice mail features can be used as if  
dialled from the cell phone.  
Phone  
12345...  
Register  
C
Answer options  
Voice mail  
1
7
2
5
3
6
Answer optio
Phone  
8
0
Register  
Auto answer  
Off  
On  
Phone options  
12 : 26 pm  
*
OK  
Voice mail  
Answer options  
Phone  
12345678910  
Phone options  
Register  
C
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0335NAS  
Voice mail  
1
4
7
2
5
3
6
9
Answer options  
1. Select Answer options.  
2. Auto answer.  
8
0
Phone options  
*
OK  
If automatic answer is on the call will  
automatically answer after a few  
seconds.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0333NAS  
Select Off or On.  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Phone options  
Phone  
Phone  
2
3
Portable's inband tone  
Register  
Ringtones  
Phonebook  
Ringtone  
Ringtone  
Ringtone  
Ringtone  
1
Voice mail  
2
Answer options  
3
1
4
Phone options  
12 : 26 pm  
Phone  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0336NAS  
1. Select Phone options 1.  
Portable's inband tone  
2. Ringtones (Ringtone options).  
Ringtone  
Ringtone  
Ringtone  
Ringtone  
1
3. Phonebook (Phonebook options).  
2
Ringtones  
3
Four ringtones are available (for in vehicle  
ringing) or you can use your cell phone’s  
own ring tone:  
4
12 : 26 pm  
Select Ringtones 2, Select Portable’s  
inband tone to use your cell phones  
ringtone.  
JAG0337NAS  
Or select Ringtone 1, 2, 3 or 4 to use a  
Jaguar preset ringtone.  
Note: Not all phones support inband  
ringing.  
Note:  
The system will store the ring tone setting  
associated with each cell phone i.e. can  
be set for each paired cell phone.  
Note: If the phone is set to silent or  
vibrate, inband ringing may not be  
available.  
Phonebook  
The phone book option 3, refer to the  
illustration on the previous page, allows  
you to automatically download your cell  
phones directory, erase it from the  
vehicle’s memory or refresh it.  
The system can store a maximum of 750  
entries although this figure varies,  
depending on the type of cell phone used,  
see Phonebook capacity on page -217.  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Note: It may take several minutes to copy  
Erase entire phonebook  
the phone book to the vehicle, depending  
on the phone and number of entries  
stored. The telephone system may not be  
operational during this period.  
To erase the entire phone book directory:  
Select Phone options 1, see page see  
Phone options on page -215. Press  
Phonebook 3.  
Auto download  
Any phone numbers stored in your cell  
phone book can be copied to the  
vehicle’s phone system.  
Phone  
Auto  
Register  
Off  
On  
Download  
Erase entire phonebook  
Voice mail  
If auto download is ON, the cell phone  
phonebook will be transferred to the  
vehicle every time the phone is connected  
(docked).  
Answer options  
Phone options  
This feature will only work on phones that  
support AT Phonebook Profile, refer to  
your phone’s handbook.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0551NAS  
Select Erase entire phonebook.  
To change auto download: Select Phone  
options 1. Press Phonebook 3, see  
Phone options.  
Phone  
Auto  
Register  
Off  
On  
Download  
Phone  
Voice mail  
Erase entire phonebook  
Phone  
Auto  
Answer options  
Register  
Off  
On  
Download  
OK  
Cancel  
Erase ebook  
Voice mail  
Phone options  
Answer options  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0552NAS  
Phone options  
A pop-up window alerts you, that you are  
about to Erase entire phonebook. Select  
OK to remove all names from the vehicle  
directory.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0550NAS  
Select Off or On.  
To delete one or more names but not all,  
see Names on page -218.  
Note:  
This feature deletes phonebook entries  
stored in the vehicle memory and not  
those stored in the cell phone memory.  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Phonebook capacity  
Certain cell phones store the phone book  
in two different areas, the SIM card and  
the phone memory. Where possible the  
vehicle will display both SIM card and  
phone memory entries up to a maximum  
of 750 entries. With some cell phones, the  
number of entries from one or both of  
these area may be restricted, it is not  
always possible to transfer addresses  
stored in one or both of these areas.  
Home  
Audio  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
1.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
The number of entries displayed is  
dependant upon the number of SIM and  
phone memory entries support by the cell  
phone.  
Phone  
01926648100  
Digit Dial  
Settings  
Names  
Last 10  
1
4
2
5
8
3
6
9
Options  
Note: Certain cell phones do not allow  
phone book entries stored on the SIM  
card to be transferred via Bluetooth.  
However, it may be possible to transfer  
the SIM phone book to the cell phone’s  
memory, before copying it to the vehicle  
phone book. Refer to your cell phone  
manual for more information. It is  
C
*
0
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0342NAS  
Changing a phone number  
advisable to remove duplicate and blank  
entries from the cell phone before the  
phone book is downloaded.  
When dialling a number, you can change  
the phone number shown on the touch  
screen display using the C button.  
A momentary press erases any single  
digit, a long press erases the complete  
number.  
USING YOUR PHONE  
Making a Call  
Before you make a call, your cell phone  
must be connected or paired and docked  
with the vehicle’s Bluetooth system, see  
SETTING UP YOUR PHONE on  
page -211  
Ending a Call  
The preferred method to end a call is to  
use the hands-free controls on the  
steering wheel, see page 220.  
From the Home menu screen select  
Phone.  
Key in the phone number, including the  
area code, if applicable. The number will  
be displayed, press the connect icon.  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Privacy: Allows the use of the cell phone  
itself and only sends the audio to the cell  
phone speaker not the vehicle speakers.  
Phone  
01926648100  
00:03:24  
Digit Dial  
Settings  
Options  
Note: Some phones will switch off the  
Bluetooth link to the vehicle when in  
Privacy mode.  
Names  
Last 10  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
C
Ending a received call  
*
0
To end the call, see Ending a Call on  
page -217 above.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0343NAS  
Names  
Alternatively, to end a call press end call  
Directory name search and Deleting  
names  
icon.  
Receiving a call  
From the Home menu screen select  
Phone.  
If the audio system is in use when the  
phone becomes active, the audio system  
source is suppressed for the duration of  
the call.  
Select Names.  
Home  
Audio  
If automatic answer has been  
programmed the call will automatically  
answer after a few seconds, see Answer  
options on page -214.  
Climate  
Phone  
External  
Left  
62  
Right  
F
Radio  
90.7 FM1  
KALX  
To answer  
1.5 F 70.0 F  
Navigation  
Vehicle  
The preferred method to accept an  
incoming call, if auto answer is not  
active, is to use the hands-free controls  
on the steering wheel, see page 220.  
Alternatively, you can accept or reject the  
incoming call from the pop-up displayed  
on the touch-screen.  
12 : 26 pm  
Valet  
Phone  
Digit Dial  
Search letter  
ABC  
Settings  
Names  
Last 10  
DEF  
In-call options  
GHI  
JKL  
TUV  
MNO  
When in a telephone call, Options may be  
selected to Microphone mute or  
Privacy.  
PQRS  
WXYZ  
OK  
Microphone mute: This will mute your  
telephone microphone so that the  
receiver of the call cannot hear you.  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0344NAS  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Last 10 option  
The Last 10 option allows you to view the  
last 10 calls made, received or missed.  
Phone  
Digit Dial  
Search letter  
ABC  
Settings  
From the home menu screen select  
Phone.  
Names  
Last 10  
DEF  
GHI  
JKL  
MNO  
WXYZ  
PQRS  
TUV  
Phone  
OK  
Digit Dial  
Names  
2
Settings  
12 : 26 pm  
Calls made  
Calls received  
Calls missed  
Last 10  
3
Phone  
Digit Dial  
M
Settings  
1
Names  
Last 10  
ABC  
JKL  
TUV  
DEF  
4
12 : 26 pm  
GHI  
MNO  
WX
JAG0346NAS  
PQRS  
1. Select Last 10.  
OK  
2. Select Calls made.  
3. Select Calls received or  
4. Select Calls missed.  
12 : 26 pm  
Phone  
Mark Home  
Mark Work  
Melissa  
Delete  
Delete  
Delete  
Phone  
Mark Work  
Mia Mobile  
Mike Home  
Delete  
elete  
01926648100  
Kate  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0345NAS  
Erin Mobile  
Kieran Home  
1. Using the keyboard select the first  
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0347NAS  
letter of the contact name.  
If name begins with the second or  
third letter on the button, press the  
button two or three time respectively.  
The search fields are opened and a list of  
calls made, received or missed are listed,  
with the most recent at the top.  
For example, if the name required was  
Oliver, the MNO button should be  
pressed three times.  
To make or return a call select the name  
from the list, your call will be routed  
automatically.  
2. Select OK.  
3. Select the desired name to make a  
call. Or select Delete to remove the  
name from the directory.  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Note:  
Making/Ending a call  
To dial:  
The vehicle will display the list in the order  
that they are sent from the cell phone.  
Some phones may arrange the list in  
reverse or other order.  
Key in the phone number, including the  
area code. The number will be displayed.  
To connect press:  
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS  
on the steering wheel or  
Four system adjustment controls are  
situated on the left-hand side of the  
steering wheel, duplicating functions of  
buttons on the touch screen. The  
preferred method of use is by these  
buttons to minimise driver distraction.  
on the touch screen.  
To end the call press:  
on the steering wheel or  
1
2
on the touch screen.  
Continuity of calls  
Whilst in a call, the call remains  
connected if the vehicle is in  
convenience mode. When the call ends,  
another call cannot be made or received  
through the vehicle system unless the  
ignition system is ON and the  
4
3
JAG0348G  
1. Scroll up/down to increase or  
decrease volume.  
touch-screen system active  
(START/STOP button pressed).  
2. Scroll up/down to next/previous  
memory location.  
3. SOURCE.  
4. Press and hold to access phone  
mode.  
Momentarily press and release to exit  
phone mode.  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Telephone  
Other features  
Do not disturb mode  
Phone  
Digit Dial  
Settings  
Options  
Phone  
Names  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
Digit Dial  
Names  
Do not disturb mode  
Settings  
Last 10  
1
4
7
3
6
9
Options  
2
C
Last 10  
5
1
*
0
8
C
12 : 26 pm  
Phone  
3  
*
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0352NAS  
If you do not wish to be  
1
2
3
disturbed by incoming phone  
calls press the bell icon 1 on the  
Options  
4
5
6
touch screen. A visual representation will  
be displayed on the touch screen to  
advise the driver that Do not disturb mode  
is selected 3 and Do not disturb mode  
will be visible when in telephone mode (2).  
Any incoming calls will be rejected or  
diverted to voice mail, see 214.  
7
8
9
C
0
*
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0353NAS  
Select the zoom icon to enlarge the  
keypad size.  
Keyboard zoom  
This option allows the user to increase the  
keyboard size.  
Phone  
1
2
3
When making a call using your numerical  
key pad displayed on the touch screen,  
the zoom icon becomes selectable.  
Options  
4
5
6
7
8
9
C
0
*
12 : 26 pm  
JAG0354NAS  
Select the zoom icon again to reduce the  
size.  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Emergency Equipment  
Chapter  
7
FIRE EXTINGUISHER  
WARNING TRIANGLE  
A warning triangle, designed to  
international standards, is standard  
equipment in certain countries.  
!
WARNING:  
Do not use a fire extinguisher closer  
than 2.4 m (8 feet) to the base of a liquid  
fire as the force may splatter the  
Coupe: The warning triangle is stowed  
under the luggage compartment load  
floor.  
burning liquid to the surrounding area.  
Convertible: The warning triangle is  
stowed in the luggage compartment lid.  
Dealer Fitted Fire Extinguisher  
Your Jaguar Dealer can supply and fit  
one.  
Mexico only: The two warning triangles  
are stored in a bag stowed in the luggage  
compartment.  
Factory Fitted Fire Extinguisher  
Mexican vehicles have a factory fitted fire  
extinguisher which contains 1.0 kg (2.2 lb)  
of BC powder pressurised with nitrogen  
to a working pressure of 12 bar (180 psi)  
at 20°C (68°F).  
In an emergency, remove the triangle(s)  
and unfold its stand legs. Place the  
triangle(s) in the road in accordance with  
local traffic regulations to give oncoming  
traffic warning of an immobilised vehicle.  
This extinguisher can be used on liquid  
fires, electrical equipment fires and, if no  
explosion risk, gasoline fires.  
Hazard warning lights must be used with  
the warning triangle.  
FIRST AID KIT  
Your Jaguar Dealer has first aid kits  
available.  
To operate the fire extinguisher, follow the  
instructions as stated on the extinguisher.  
Do not test the fire extinguisher prior to  
use. Partial discharge will render the  
extinguisher inoperative.  
Maintenance  
Every six months:  
Remove the extinguisher from its  
bracket and check that the nozzle is  
clear.  
Check that any fitted safety devices  
are secure.  
If fitted, check pressure gauge is  
reading within limits. If the gauge is  
indicating incorrect limits, the  
extinguisher may not work in an  
emergency. Seek qualified assistance  
immediately.  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Status After a Collision  
Status After  
a
Collision  
2. Press the engine START/STOP button  
again, without pressing the brake  
pedal, to turn the ignition ON. Wait 30  
seconds.  
DRIVING AFTER A COLLISION  
If the vehicle is involved in a collision, the  
functionality of the vehicle could be  
reduced.  
3. Make a further check for fuel leaks.  
Depending upon the severity of the  
collision the following vehicle functions  
may come into effect:  
4. Press the START/STOP button with  
the brake pedal depressed to start the  
engine as normal.  
engine shut down  
inertia switch tripped, which cuts off  
the fuel pumps  
MOVING THE VEHICLE  
If the engine starts, the vehicle may be  
moved carefully to a position of safety. Do  
not move the vehicle further than  
necessary.  
doors unlock  
hazard and interior lights come on (the  
hazard lights will remain on until the  
inertia switch is reset)  
Recovery  
the message centre will display  
INERTIA SWITCH TRIPPED  
Even if the vehicle appears driveable after  
the collision, it should not be driven or  
towed. Concealed damage could make  
the vehicle impossible to manoeuvre. See  
page 224.  
exterior lights will maintain their state.  
ATTEMPTING TO START THE  
VEHICLE  
!
WARNING:  
To reduce the risk of fire or personal  
injury, do not under any  
circumstances, attempt to start the  
vehicle if you see or smell fuel.  
The inertia switch may have been tripped  
by the collision. This will cut off the fuel  
pumps. The switch must be reset before  
the engine will start.  
Resetting the switch  
If no fuel leak is apparent:  
1. Press the engine START/STOP  
button, without pressing the brake  
pedal, to turn the ignition back to  
convenience mode (ignition OFF).  
Wait for approximately 10 seconds.  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Recovery  
Vehicle Recovery  
TRANSPORTING THE VEHICLE  
JAG0355G  
Jaguar strongly recommend that the  
vehicle is recovered by use of a slide-bed  
recovery transporter only.  
Transporting  
If the vehicle is being transported the  
parkbrake must be applied, the wheels  
chocked and the gear selector lever  
moved to position N or D but never to P.  
Caution:  
Ensure that the recovery team do  
not tow with sling-type,  
While the vehicle is being loaded, the  
Jaguar Smart Key should be placed in the  
starter control unit. This will prevent the  
steering lock activating.  
spectacle-type or towing dolly  
equipment as damage to the front  
or rear underside bodywork may  
result.  
The vehicle must be securely tied down to  
the transporter or trailer. Use straps on  
the front wheels and tires to secure the  
vehicle for transportation.  
If the vehicle has an inoperable  
transmission, to prevent further  
damage, it must be towed with the  
rear wheels clear of the ground.  
The towing eye is not designed for  
securing the vehicle during  
transportation.  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Recovery  
Vehicle failure  
!
WARNING:  
Without the engine running, the brake  
servo and power steering pump cannot  
provide assistance: greater effort will  
therefore be required to operate the  
brake pedal and turn the steering  
wheel. Longer stopping distances will  
also be experienced.  
The removable towing eye is primarily for  
emergency use when towing for short  
distances, e.g. removing the vehicle if it is  
causing an obstruction or for winching the  
vehicle onto a recovery transporter. To  
prevent damage while the vehicle is being  
towed with the rear wheels on the ground,  
towing distance must be restricted to  
0.8 kilometres (0.5 miles). Towing speed  
must not exceed 48 km/h (30 mph).  
When being towed, the transmission must  
be in neutral (N) with the ignition system  
switched to convenience mode to  
release the steering lock and render the  
indicators, horn and brake lights  
operational.  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Recovery  
A screw-in front towing eye is provided in  
TOWING POINTS  
the luggage compartment with the jack.  
The towing eye has a left-hand thread and  
must be screwed in a counter-clockwise  
direction when fitting.  
1
The front towing point is located behind a  
plastic cover on the left-hand side of the  
vehicle (as viewed from the front).  
1. To access the towing point, press the  
plastic cover on the top to unclip.  
Remove the cover.  
2
2. Screw the towing eye into the vehicle,  
right up to the shoulder.  
3. The rear tie-down point is in the centre  
of the vehicle to the rear of the  
exhaust silencer.  
Use this point only when the vehicle is  
to be towed rearwards on straight  
level ground for the least amount of  
distance possible or loading onto a  
recovery vehicle.  
3
JAG0356G  
!
WARNING:  
Avoid body contact with a hot exhaust  
pipe when fitting any equipment to the  
rear towing points.  
Caution:  
The towing eye is not suitable for  
solid bar towing.  
Care must be taken to avoid  
damaging the bumpers and front  
apron.  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
Chapter  
8
Do not use a dry cloth to wipe dirty  
paintwork. Dust and gritty substances are  
abrasive and will scratch the paintwork.  
Remove dirt using a cellulose sponge and  
plenty of warm (never hot) water. Rinse off  
with clean water and dry using a clean,  
damp chamois leather.  
!
WARNING:  
Many liquids and other substances  
used in vehicles are poisonous and  
should never be consumed and must  
be kept away from open wounds.  
These substances include antifreeze,  
brake fluid, fuel, windshield washer  
additives, lubricants and various  
adhesives.  
Do not use household soaps or  
detergents. The use of Jaguar Vehicle  
Shampoo is recommended.  
Caution: Read individual product  
warnings before using any car cleaning  
or washing products.  
Using an automatic wash  
Caution:  
Ensure that AUTO, wipers, is not  
selected when entering a car wash  
or damage to the wiper blades and  
arms can occur as they will operate  
in the car wash.  
CLEANING PRODUCTS  
!
WARNING:  
Dry cleaning fluids may be toxic or  
flammable. Take adequate precautions  
when handling these products.  
Ensure that the audio system is  
turned OFF so that the aerial is  
retracted.  
Brush and clean the interior regularly. Use  
a vacuum cleaner where possible to  
remove all dust from the interior and trim.  
Note: Regular use of automatic car  
washes tends to dull the lustre of the  
paintwork.  
CLEANING THE EXTERIOR  
After leaving the car wash, switch on the  
windshield wiper immediately to remove  
water and prevent a build up of wax.  
Convertible top fabric  
Caution:  
Do not use an automatic car wash  
that has rotating brushes.  
The action of the brushes may  
damage the exterior fabric or the  
seals of the convertible top.  
Do not use spot cleaners, chemical  
dilutants or any organic cleaners. If  
in doubt, contact your Jaguar  
Dealer.  
JAG0437G  
Washing your vehicle  
For best results, do not wash the vehicle  
under strong sunlight. Always allow the  
vehicle to cool down before washing.  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
To maintain the appearance and  
The Jaguar Aerial Cleaning Kit contains  
the necessary maintenance items.  
condition of the convertible top, the  
recommendations given below should be  
followed. This is of particular importance  
in the case of light coloured tops.  
Using a high pressure washer  
Caution: Some high pressure cleaning  
systems are sufficiently powerful to  
penetrate door and window seals and  
damage rubbing strips and locking  
mechanisms. Never aim the water jet  
directly at heater air intakes, body  
seals, the convertible top, or at any  
componant that might easily be  
damaged.  
Do not leave the top in the open (folded)  
position for longer than is necessary, as in  
certain circumstances permanent soiling  
along the folds may occur.  
Cleaning: Every 1 600 km (1 000 miles)  
vacuum clean and wash the convertible  
top using the Jaguar Soft Top Cleaning  
Kit, carefully following the instructions  
enclosed.  
When salt is used on the roads, wash the  
vehicle immediately after encountering  
such conditions. Clean undersides and  
wheel arches using a high pressure jet.  
Reproofing: Every 8 000 km (5 000 miles)  
reproof the top using the solution in the  
cleaning kit, carefully following the  
instructions enclosed.  
Underhood cleaning  
Caution: Do not use a high pressure  
washer or steam cleaner in the engine  
compartment. Damage to components  
could occur.  
Preparation for Winter  
Before the onset of Winter, it is advisable  
to coat the convertible top seals and  
respective body seals with a compound,  
such as Carbaflo KSP 105, to aid  
Glass surfaces  
operation in freezing conditions.  
Clean the rear window with a soft cloth to  
avoid damaging the heating element. DO  
NOT scrape the glass or use any abrasive  
cleaning fluid.  
This action will need to be repeated at the  
start of each Winter to maintain  
protection.  
Mirror glass is particularly susceptible to  
damage. Wash with soapy water. DO  
NOT use abrasive cleaning compounds or  
metal scrapers to remove ice.  
Care must be taken so that the compound  
does not come into contact with the  
convertible top material. For further  
advise you should contact your Jaguar  
Dealer.  
The following products will ensure glass  
surfaces and windshield wipers are kept  
in good condition:  
Aerial care  
Regular cleaning with a special aerial  
cleaner, will ensure smooth and reliable  
operation of the aerial.  
Jaguar Screen Clean Paste – Apply to the  
exterior of the windshield only to ensure  
effective operation of the windshield  
wiper.  
In freezing conditions check that no ice  
has formed over the top of the aerial,  
which could prevent it being raised and  
cause damage to the motor.  
Jaguar Glass Cleaner – Interior and  
exterior of all other glass surfaces.  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
Jaguar Screen Wash – Washer reservoir  
Polishing  
additive.  
For maximum protection against road  
dust, salts, industrial fall-out etc., it is  
recommended that the vehicle is polished  
regularly using Jaguar polish and a  
polishing cloth.  
Jaguar Winter Care Kit comprising  
de-icer, ice scraper, anti-mist wipe cloth  
and aerial cleaner – for use in adverse  
weather conditions.  
Note: The vehicle’s brightwork should be  
cleaned in the same way as the paintwork:  
Chrome polish or other abrasive cleaners  
must not be used.  
Cleaning the rear screen  
To avoid damaging the heating elements,  
when cleaning the inside of the rear  
screen use only a soft damp cloth or  
chamois leather. Do not use solvents or  
sharp objects to clean the glass.  
CLEANING THE INTERIOR  
Caution: To prevent airbag damage,  
the steering wheel centre pad and  
other areas containing airbags should  
only be cleaned sparingly with a damp  
cloth, warm water and a non-detergent  
soap. Do not allow these areas to be  
flooded with chemical solvents, liquids,  
furniture cream or polishes.  
Care of alloy road wheels  
The alloy road wheels are covered with a  
protective anti-corrosion coating. To  
prevent corrosion it is essential that this  
coating is not damaged.  
When removing or fitting tires always  
advise the tire fitter to treat the alloy  
wheels with great care. Tire levers must  
not be used.  
Leather  
Leather is an easy to maintain natural  
product, however, dust and substances  
can penetrate the pores and crease the  
leather, causing surface wear and  
brittleness.  
Wash the wheels regularly with soap and  
water to avoid an accumulation of  
particles. In salty conditions the wheels  
should be cleaned more frequently.  
To prevent ingrained dirt and staining,  
inspect the seat upholstery regularly and  
clean every one to two months as follows:  
Jaguar acid-free wheel cleaner can be  
used to remove heavy soiling. Do not use  
non-approved acid based cleaners.  
Wipe off fine dust from the seat  
surfaces using a clean, damp,  
non-coloured cloth. Change  
frequently to a clean area of cloth to  
avoid abrasive action on the leather  
surface. Avoid over-wetting.  
Removing Grease and Tar  
Remove grease or tar with Jaguar Tar  
Remover or methylated spirit (alcohol).  
White spirit is also effective, but must not  
be applied to rubber, particularly the  
windshield wiper blades.  
If this is not sufficient, use a cloth  
which has been dampened with warm  
soapy water and then wrung out. Use  
only mild non-caustic soap.  
Bird Droppings  
Do not allow bird droppings or tree sap to  
harden. Remove from paintwork  
immediately with a lukewarm soap and  
water solution.  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
Use Jaguar Leather Cleaner for  
Cloth and fabric  
Caution:  
heavily soiled areas. Dry off and rub  
with a clean soft cloth, changing  
surfaces regularly.  
Never use soap, ammonia, bleach  
or other cleaners intended for use  
on hard surfaces.  
When staining (e.g. from clothing) or  
spillage occurs, clean the affected area  
immediately as described above.  
Do not use upholstery cleaner on  
electrical equipment such as facia  
switches.  
Use Jaguar Leather Cleaner several times  
a year to maintain its appearance and  
suppleness. The cleaner will nourish and  
moisturise and help to improve the  
surface protective film against dust and  
substances.  
When cleaning around electrical  
equipment such as switches,  
ensure that fluids do not leak into  
any gaps around the components  
or between panels or trim.  
Do not use solvents. Do not use  
detergents, furniture polish or  
Use Jaguar Upholstery Cleaner, following  
the instructions. Do not over wet.  
household cleaners. While these  
products may initially give impressive  
results, their use will lead to rapid  
deterioration of the leather and will  
invalidate the warranty. Jaguar  
recommend a basic set of products  
that have been specially selected for  
the type of leather in your vehicle.  
Removing stains  
Most stains on woollen fabric can be  
removed if treatment is carried out  
immediately, before the stain has a  
chance to dry-in.  
Most stains can be treated with one of  
three cleaning fluids: Jaguar Upholstery  
Cleaner, dry cleaning fluid or clean water.  
Follow the instructions on the package.  
Dark clothing may stain leather seats  
just like other upholstery products.  
Sharp objects such as belts, zip  
fasteners, rivets, etc. can leave  
permanent scratches and scratch  
marks on the leather surface.  
Carpet and mats  
Marks or stains can be removed by gentle  
scrubbing with a weak solution of soap  
and warm water.  
Unless spillages such as tea, coffee or  
ink are washed away immediately,  
permanent staining may have to be  
accepted.  
For more stubborn stains a commercially  
available carpet cleaner should be used.  
If a valet service is used, ensure that the  
specialist concerned is aware of, and  
follows these instructions precisely.  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Care  
Floor mat retention  
JAG0357L  
The driver’s floor mat must be correctly  
positioned and secured under the  
tongues on the retention posts (only one  
post shown). Ensure that the mat does  
not interfere with the operation of the  
accelerator or brake pedal.  
REPAIRING MINOR PAINT  
DAMAGE  
Paint chips  
Scratches and chips should be touched in  
before weathering action begins. Inspect  
the paintwork immediately after the  
vehicle has been washed.  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
Maintenance  
Warranty - USA and Canada  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
The Passport to Service contains  
warranties applicable to the vehicle,  
which include:  
Protect the environment  
We must all play our part in protecting the  
environment. Correct vehicle usage and  
disposal of waste cleaning and lubrication  
materials are significant steps towards  
this aim.  
The Limited Vehicle Warranty.  
The Emission Control System  
Warranty and covered parts list.  
The Corrosion Warranty.  
Avoid using high engine speeds. This will  
protect your engine, reduce fuel  
consumption, lower the engine noise level  
and help towards reducing the  
environmental burden.  
Tires are not warranted by Jaguar Cars  
Limited, but by the specific manufacturer  
of the tires on the vehicle. Details of tire  
warranties are included in the vehicle  
literature pack.  
Dispose of used parts and fluids at your  
local authorised waste disposal facilities.  
Warranty - Mexico  
Regular Servicing  
The Warranty Benefits booklet contains  
warranties applicable to the vehicle,  
which include:  
Caution: Severe damage to the  
electrical system and electronic  
components can occur if any attempt  
is made to diagnose faults in the  
electrical system using conventional  
diagnostic equipment (for example, the  
use of test lamps or low impedance  
voltmeters). The fitting of any electrical  
accessory should only be entrusted to  
a Jaguar Dealer.  
The Limited Vehicle Warranty.  
The Emission Control System  
Warranty and covered parts list.  
The Corrosion Warranty.  
Owner maintenance  
In addition to the routine services and  
inspections, a number of simple checke  
must be carried out more frequently. You  
can carry out these checks yourself.  
Regular maintenance and servicing is the  
responsibility of the owner. Failure to  
implement maintenance at the  
recommended intervals could result in  
deterioration of vehicle performance and  
possible infringement of regulations.  
Any significant or sudden drop in fluid  
levels, or uneven tyre wear, should be  
reportedtoa Jaguar Dealer/Authorised  
Repairer without delay.  
Your Jaguar Dealer will be pleased to  
arrange periodic servicing in accordance  
with the Passport to Service (USA and  
Canada) or Service Portfolio (Mexico).  
Daily checks  
Operation of lamps, horn, direction  
indicators, wipers, washers and  
warning indicators.  
Operation of seat belts and brakes.  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
Look for fluid deposits underneath the  
vehicle that might indicate a leak.  
Condensation drips from air  
conditioning is normal.  
Weekly checks  
Engine oil level.  
Note: The engine oil level should be  
checked more frequently if the vehicle  
is driven for prolonged periods at high  
speeds.  
Brake fluid level.  
Power steering fluid level.  
Screen washer fluid level.  
Tyre pressures and condition.  
Operate air conditioning.  
Monthly  
Wiper blades - Check the quality of the  
wipe. If smearing or juddering is evident,  
clean the windshield and renew the wiper  
blades.  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
OPENING AND CLOSING THE  
HOOD  
!
WARNING:  
Before closing the hood ensure that no  
one is obstructing the closing area and  
that hands and clothes are clear.  
!
WARNING:  
When working within the engine  
compartment, take care to avoid  
contact with moving parts and hot  
components.  
Caution: Do not press downward on  
the top of the hood to close it,  
especially within the final centimetres  
(inches) of closing, as this may damage  
the hood.  
Hood latching: Close the hood to within  
a distance of 30 cm to 35 cm  
(12 to 14 inches) of the fully closed  
position, then let go to allow the hood to  
shut.  
To check that the hood is closed, pull the  
hood upwards to ensure that both the  
right-hand and left-hand latches are  
engaged.  
JAG0359G  
The hood lock release control is below the  
facia on the left-hand side of the vehicle.  
To open: Release the hood lock by  
pulling the lever. Reach across to the  
centre rear edge of the hood and lift. The  
gas filled struts will assist raising the  
hood, and retain it in the fully open  
position.  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
ENGINE COMPARTMENT  
OVERVIEW  
Normally aspirated engine  
1
2
3
4
6
5
JAG0363N  
1. Coolant reservoir.  
2. Windshield and headlamp washer  
reservoir.  
3. Engine oil filler.  
4. Brake reservoir.  
5. Engine oil dipstick.  
6. Power steering reservoir.  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
Supercharged engine  
1
2
3
4
6
5
JAG0559N  
1. Coolant reservoir.  
2. Windshield and headlamp washer  
reservoir.  
3. Engine oil filler.  
4. Brake reservoir.  
5. Engine oil dipstick.  
6. Power steering reservoir.  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
To check engine oil level  
ENGINE OIL CHECK  
Caution:  
1
2
If the message ENGINE OIL  
PRESSURE LOW is displayed, stop  
the engine immediately and seek  
qualified assistance. Do not start  
the engine until the cause has been  
identified and rectified.  
Your vehicle’s warranty may be  
invalidated if damage is caused by  
the use of improper engine oil. Low  
quality or obsolete oils do not  
provide the protection required by  
modern, highperformanceengines.  
Failure to use an oil that meets the  
required specification could cause  
excessive engine wear, a build up  
of sludge and deposits and  
JAG0364G  
Remove the dipstick 1 and wipe clean  
with a lint free cloth. Replace fully, then  
withdraw the dipstick. If the oil level is  
above the lower of the two dots on the  
dipstick then no additional oil is required.  
increased pollution. It could also  
lead to engine failure.  
If the oil level is at or below the lower of  
the two dots, remove the oil filler cap 2  
and add oil, to the quantity and  
Do not use oil additives of any type  
as engine damage could occur. Use  
only specified lubricants.  
specification shown on page 238.  
Engine oil consumption  
Refit the filler cap and hand tighten  
securely until one click is heard.  
A certain amount of oil consumption is  
normal. The rate of consumption will  
depend on the following:  
the quality and viscosity of the oil  
climatic conditions  
the speed at which the engine is being  
operated  
road conditions.  
Drivers should expect above normal  
consumption when the engine is new.  
Check the oil level regularly with the  
vehicle on flat, level ground.  
Check the oil level with the engine  
completely cold.  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
Recommended engine oil  
Jaguar recommends  
ENGINE COOLANT CHECK  
!
WARNING:  
It is unsafe to run the engine in an  
overheated condition.  
The radiator cooling fans may  
continue to run after the ignition  
has been switched off but will  
automatically switch off when the  
engine has cooled sufficiently.  
When the oil level is at the lower dipstick  
mark, add 1litres (1.1 US quart) of oil.  
Oil specification  
API SM and ILSAC GF-4.  
When topping up between  
oil changes, make sure that  
you use oil that has the  
Do not remove the coolant  
reservoir filler cap while the engine  
is hot. If it is essential, then protect  
your hands against escaping  
steam. Slowly turn the cap counter  
clockwise to allow the steam  
pressure to escape completely  
before removing the cap.  
correct quality level (API  
service) and viscosity grade.  
Note: For maximumfueleconomy, 5W-30  
oil is recommended.  
Engine oil temperature ranges  
Caution: If persistent coolant loss is  
noticed, seek qualified assistance  
immediately.  
For climates ranging from -35°C (– 31°F)  
to + 50°C (+ 122°F), the following oil  
viscosities may be used:  
0W–30 will protect from -35°C (– 31°F) to  
+ 35°C (+ 95°F).  
5W–30 (preferred) will protect from -30°C  
(–22°F) to +35°C (+95°F).  
0W–40 will protect from – 35°C (– 31°F) to  
+ 50°C (+ 122°F).  
5W–40 will protect from –30°C (–22°F) to  
+50°C (+122°F).  
JAG0365G  
Check the level only when the engine is  
cold. The coolant level should be between  
the MAX and MIN indicators. If persistent  
coolant loss is noticed, seek qualified  
assistance immediately.  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
If the message centre displays the  
WASHER FLUID CHECK  
message ENGINE OVERHEATING, pull  
over and allow the engine to idle for five  
minutes and then switch off for ten  
!
WARNING:  
Windshield washer fluid is toxic and  
in concentrated form is flammable.  
Observe all warnings on the washer  
solution container.  
minutes. Switch on and provided that the  
warning does not recur, continue your  
journey avoiding harsh acceleration. Seek  
qualified assistance as soon as possible.  
Under no circumstances must  
cooling system antifreeze be used,  
since this will damage the  
paintwork.  
Topping up  
!
WARNING:  
Do not allow antifreeze to make  
contact with skin or eyes. If this  
should happen, rinse the affected  
area immediately with plenty of  
water.  
Coolant fluid is toxic and in  
concentrated form is flammable.  
Observe all warnings indicated on  
the container.  
Caution: Antifreeze will damage  
paintwork. Wash off immediately if  
spillage occurs.  
Top up with a mixture of 50% water and  
50% antifreeze until the coolant is  
between the MAX and MIN. This 50/50%  
mixture gives frost protection for  
temperatures down  
to – 40°C (– 40°F). Use antifreeze to  
specification WSS M97B44, coloured  
orange, Extended Life Coolant.  
JAG0366G  
The washer reservoir contains the fluid for  
the windshield washers and the headlamp  
powerwash system.  
Fill with Jaguar Windshield Washer Fluid  
diluted with clean soft water as specified  
in the instructions on the bottle. Do not  
over fill.  
Refit the filler cap and hand-tighten  
securely until one click is heard.  
Using a non-approved fluid may  
adversely affect the wiper blade rubber,  
resulting in ineffectual and noisy wiping.  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
Cold weather precautions  
To prevent damage to the pump during  
freezing conditions, use Jaguar  
Windshield Washer Fluid at the strength  
shown on the bottle, for the anticipated  
ambient temperature.  
Caution: State or local regulations on  
volatile organic compounds may  
restrict the use of methanol, a common  
windshield washer anti-freeze additive.  
Washer fluids containing  
non-methanol anti-freeze agents  
should be used only if they provide cold  
weather protection without damaging  
the vehicle’s paint finish, wiper blades  
or washer system.  
BRAKE FLUID CHECK  
!
WARNING:  
The fluid level will drop as the brake  
pads wear. If the level is very low the  
brake warning indicator will illuminate  
and a message BRAKE FLUID LOW will  
be displayed. Seek qualified assistance  
immediately. Do not drive the vehicle  
until the cause is rectified as driving  
under such conditions could result in  
extended stopping distances or  
JAG0369N  
The fluid is visible through the translucent  
casing of the reservoir and must be  
maintained at the MAX mark.  
Topping up:  
1. Remove the reservoir top cover.  
complete brake failure.  
2. Clean the reservoir and cap  
thoroughly with a lint free cloth to  
ensure that no foreign matter enters  
the reservoir.  
Caution:  
While handling brake fluid, take  
extreme care; brake fluid can  
damage the vehicle paintwork.  
3. Unscrew the filler cap and top up to  
the MAX level using brake fluid to  
specification Shell DOT 4 ESL or low  
viscosity DOT 4 brake fluid that meets  
ISO 4925 class 6 specification. Only  
fluid of this type and standard may be  
used.  
Always use fresh, clean fluid from a  
new container. Never introduce  
used brake fluid into the system.  
240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance  
4. Refit the filler cap securely and refit  
If the level be very low, seek qualified  
assistance as soon as possible.  
the cover.  
POWER STEERING FLUID  
CHECK  
JAG0370G  
Caution: It is imperative that the power  
steering system does not become  
contaminated in any way. Always use  
new fluid and clean the area around the  
reservoir neck both before and after  
topping up.  
1. Check the fluid level when the engine  
is COLD and the vehicle is on a flat,  
level surface.  
2. Wipe clean and remove the filler cap  
from the reservoir; take great care to  
prevent any foreign matter from  
entering.  
3. Check that the fluid level is between  
the marks on the reservoir dipstick.  
4. If necessary, top up with DEXRON III  
power steering fluid, DO NOT  
OVERFILL.  
5. Refit the filler cap.  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Battery  
Vehicle Battery  
BATTERY WARNING SYMBOLS  
There is a label on the battery depicting a  
number of warning signs. The warning  
signs are as follows:  
No smoking, no flames, no sparks (Red).  
Shield eyes (Blue).  
JAG0443N  
1. DANGER/POISON  
2. NO  
Keep away from children (Red).  
Explosive gas (Yellow).  
SPARKS  
FLAMES  
SMOKING  
3. FLUSH EYES IMMEDIATELY  
GET MEDICAL HELP FAST  
4. SULFURIC ACID can cause blindness  
or severe burns  
5. KEEP OUT OF THE REACH OF  
CHILDREN  
Battery acid (Yellow).  
DO NOT TIP  
KEEP VENT CAP TIGHT AND LEVEL  
6. SHIELD EYES  
EXPLOSIVE GASES CAN CAUSE  
BLINDNESS OR INJURY  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Battery  
Note: Do not connect any 12 volt  
BATTERY CARE  
equipment, (for example, a 12 volt lamp),  
directly to the battery terminals. Use the  
accessory socket located in the glove box  
for connecting Jaguar approved  
accessories.  
!
WARNING:  
The cell plugs and vent pipe must  
be in place at all times when the  
battery is in the vehicle. Failure to  
fit, or incorrect fitting of these items  
is potentially hazardous. Ensure  
that the vent pipe is free from kinks  
or damage.  
Replacement batteries  
!
WARNING:  
Only fit a replacement battery of the  
same type and specification as the  
original - other batteries may vary in  
size or have different terminal  
positions which could cause a fire  
hazard when connected to the  
vehicle’s electrical system.  
If battery acid comes into contact  
with skin or eyes immediately rinse  
with cold water and consult a  
doctor.  
Never charge or boost a frozen  
battery.  
Switch off ignition before  
Battery disposal  
disconnecting battery terminals.  
Always disconnect the ground  
terminal first and reconnect last.  
Used batteries should be recycled.  
However, batteries are hazardous - you  
should seek advice about disposal from a  
Jaguar Dealer or your local authority.  
Do not let battery acid come into  
contact with painted surfaces or  
fabric.  
USING BOOSTER CABLES  
California Proposition 65:  
Battery posts, terminals and related  
accessories, contain lead and lead  
compounds. Wash hands after  
handling.  
!
WARNING:  
Always wear appropriate eye  
protection when working with  
batteries.  
A low maintenance battery specifically  
designed for use with this vehicle is fitted  
in the luggage compartment.  
During normal use, batteries emit  
explosive hydrogen gas - ensure  
sparks and naked lights are kept  
away from the engine  
In hot climates more frequent checks of  
the battery electrolyte level are required. If  
necessary, the battery cells can be  
topped up with distilled water.  
compartment.  
Do not attempt to start the vehicle if  
the electrolyte in the battery is  
suspected of being frozen.  
The exterior of the battery should be  
occasionally wiped clean to remove any  
dirt or grease.  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Battery  
Make sure both batteries are of the  
Using booster cables (jump leads) from a  
donor battery, or a battery fitted to a  
donor vehicle, is the only approved  
method of starting a vehicle with a  
discharged battery. Thisprocedure differs  
to that used to charge a battery, which  
should not be attempted with the battery  
connected to the vehicle.  
same voltage (12 volts), and that the  
booster cables have insulated  
clamps and are approved for use  
with 12 volt batteries.  
Do not disconnect the discharged  
battery.  
Do not connect positive (+)  
terminals to negative (-) terminals,  
and ensure booster cables are kept  
away from any moving parts in the  
engine compartment.  
Boosting from another vehicle  
!
WARNING:  
Do not use a 24 volt booster start  
system. These produce excessive  
voltage and can damage the vehicle’s  
electrical system.  
Take care when working near  
rotating parts of the engine.  
Caution:  
If using a boost start vehicle, under  
If a donor vehicle is to be used, both  
vehicles should be parked with their  
battery locations adjacent to each other.  
Ensure that the two vehicles do not touch.  
no circumstances should the  
vehicles come into contact with  
each other. This could establish an  
earth connection, which may cause  
sparks and damage.  
Apply the parkbrakes and ensure that the  
transmission of both vehicles is set in  
neutral (P - park for vehicles with  
automatic transmission).  
Do not run the boost start vehicle’s  
engine when boost starting a  
Jaguar vehicle. If the boost start  
vehicle’s engine is running and the  
jump leads are disconnected,  
damage to the Jaguar vehicle’s  
electrical system will result.  
Ensure that both vehicles have all  
electrical services OFF.  
Where the booster cables are of a  
different colour, e.g. red and black, use  
red for positive (+). This aids identification  
and helps to avoid crossing positive (+) to  
negative (–). Take extra care to avoid  
crossing the polarity when using cables of  
the same colour.  
This vehicle is fitted with automatic  
transmission. In the event of a discharged  
battery preventing a normal engine start,  
the vehicle cannot be started by pushing  
or towing. Either use booster cables  
connected to a booster battery (e.g. on  
another vehicle) or fit a fully charged  
battery.  
244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Battery  
Procedure for using booster cables  
4. Attach one end of the black jump lead  
to the negative (-) terminal of the  
booster battery and the other end to  
the negative (-) terminal of the vehicle  
battery remote charge terminal.  
5. Start the disabled vehicle. Allow the  
engine to idle for five minutes before  
disconnecting the cables.  
6. Disconnect the black jump lead from  
the negative (-) terminal of the vehicle  
battery remote charge terminal and  
the booster battery negative (-)  
terminal.  
7. Disconnect the red jump lead from the  
positive (+) remote charge terminal of  
the vehicle and the booster battery  
positive (+) terminal.  
8. Refit the terminal covers, trim panel  
and luggage compartment floor  
panel.  
It may be necessary to reset the electric  
parkbrake, see page 164. See also 246.  
JAG0373G  
The following procedure must be followed  
exactly:  
CHARGING THE VEHICLE  
BATTERY  
1. Remove the left-hand side luggage  
compartment trim panel cover to  
access the vehicle battery positive (+)  
remote charge terminal, remove the  
protective cap from the terminal.  
!
WARNING:  
Batteries produce combustible gas  
(hydrogen) when being charged. The  
battery must be removed from the  
vehicle before charging commences.  
2. Attach one end of the red jump lead to  
the positive (+) terminal of the booster  
battery and the other end to the  
positive (+) remote charge terminal of  
the vehicle battery.  
Due to the restricted accessibility of the  
centrally located battery, charging of the  
battery should be assigned to qualified  
assistance.  
3. Lift the luggage compartment floor  
panel to reveal the spare wheel.  
Remove the protective cap from the  
negative (-) terminal of the vehicle  
battery remote charge terminal.  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Battery  
If the message BATTERY NOT  
When the vehicle main battery is  
disconnected and then reconnected, the  
security system immediately returns to  
the state that it was when the battery was  
disconnected.  
CHARGING is displayed there is either a  
generator or battery fault. Turn off all  
electrical accessories, radio, climate  
control etc. Try to use minimum electrical  
load as possible such as power windows,  
convertible top etc. Seek qualified  
assistance as soon as possible.  
Note: Ensure that a remote handset is  
available to disarm the system when  
reconnecting the battery. Either press the  
unlock button on the transmitter, or press  
the START/STOP button for  
Effects of battery disconnection  
After reconnecting the battery:  
convenience mode.  
Reset the electric parkbrake; see  
page 164.  
Reset the electrically operated  
windows anti-trap function; see page  
87.  
The trip computer will lose all  
recorded trip data and all trip  
functions will be reset to zero. The  
vehicle total odometer reading is  
retained.  
If the battery is disconnected for more  
than 72 hours the radio preset  
channels will need to be reset.  
Reset the clock to the correct time,  
see page 142.  
Recalibrate the seat memory  
positions; see page 139.  
The engine electronic control system  
automatically adapts to certain  
characteristics of the vehicle. When the  
battery is disconnected, these  
adaptations are lost.  
On reconnection, therefore, some slightly  
abnormal drive symptoms may occur and  
the vehicle may need to be driven  
16 kilometers (10 miles) or more while the  
control system re-adapts.  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Wheels and Tires  
A slight pressure loss occurs naturally  
TIRE CARE  
with time. If this exceeds 0.14 bar  
2
Tire glossary  
(2 lbf/in , 14 kPa) per week, have the  
Refer to page 278 for a glossary of terms  
and definitions associated with tire  
pressures and vehicle weights.  
cause investigated and rectified by a  
qualified assistance.  
If winter tires are fitted, please refer to the  
winter tire pressure information on page  
265.  
Tire pressures  
Tire pressure label  
(Canada and Mexico only)  
A tire recommendation label is located on  
the end of driver’s door, giving  
information specific to the vehicle’s wheel  
and tire equipment.  
!
WARNING:  
Improperly inflated tires can affect  
vehicle handling and can fail suddenly,  
possibly resulting in loss of vehicle  
control.  
Caution: Never exceed the maximum  
pressure stated on the sidewall. Over  
inflation could cause the tire to fail  
suddenly.  
These pressures provide optimum ride  
and handling characteristics for all normal  
operating conditions.  
In the interest of safety, reliability and fuel  
efficiency, check the tires, including the  
spare, for condition and pressure on a  
weekly basis and before long journeys.  
Pressure checks must be carried out  
when the tires are cold and the vehicle  
has been standing in ambient local  
conditions for at least one hour.  
Do not check tire pressures immediately  
after the vehicle has travelled in excess of  
1.6 km (1mile). Tire temperatures and  
pressures increase when running.  
JAG0057G  
Deflating a warm tire to the recommended  
pressure will result in under inflation.  
If tire pressures are checked while the  
vehicle is inside a protected covered area,  
e.g. a garage, and subsequently driven in  
lower outdoor temperatures, tire under  
inflation could occur.  
256  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Tire pressure label/placard (USA only)  
1
2
3
TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION  
SEATING CAPACITY  
TOTAL 4  
FRONT 2  
REAR 2  
4
The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXXkg or XXXXlbs  
TIRE  
SIZE  
COLD TIRE INFLATION PRESSURE  
SEE OWNER’S  
MANUAL FOR  
ADDITIONAL  
XXX/XXRXX  
XXPSI  
XXXkpa  
FRONT  
XXX/XXRXX  
XXPSI  
XXPSI  
XXXkpa  
XXXkpa  
REAR  
INFORMATION  
RCT5490  
TXXX/XXRXX  
SPARE  
6
5
JAG0394N  
A tire information label is visible on the  
pillar behind the driver’s door (also known  
as the B pillar), giving information specific  
to the wheel and tire equipment fitted to  
the vehicle when it was built.  
Cold inflation pressures for the front,  
rear and spare tire 5.  
The size of the tires 6 with which the  
vehicle was originally equipped.  
Note: The label must not be changed,  
even if different wheels are fitted at a  
later stage.  
These pressures provide optimum ride  
and handling characteristics for all normal  
operating conditions.  
The label contains the following  
information:  
The maximum number of occupants  
1, divided between the front 2 and  
rear 3 of the vehicle.  
The vehicle capacity weight 4, which  
includes the weight of the driver,  
passengers and cargo.  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Recommended tire pressures  
The following table gives the tire pressures for all recommended tire sizes:  
Tire Size  
Tire Pressure  
Front  
Rear  
2
245/45ZR18 100Z  
275/40ZR18 103Z  
245/40ZR19 94Y  
275/35ZR19 96Y  
255/35ZR20 97Y  
285/30ZR20 99Y  
-
210 k Pa (30 lb/in )  
-
2
227.5 kPa (33 lb/in )  
-
2
210 kPa (30 lb/in )  
2
-
227.5 kPa (33 lb/in )  
2
-
210 kPa (30 lb/in )  
2
-
227.5 kPa (33 lb/in )  
19 inch run-flat:  
245/40R19 RSC 94Y  
-
-
-
2
210 kPa (30 lb/in )  
2
275/35R19 RSC 96Y  
-
227.5 kPa (33 lb/in )  
2
Temporary use spare wheel (front or rear)  
420 kPa (60 lb/in )  
Checking tire pressures  
A slight natural pressure loss occurs with  
time. If this exceeds 14 kPa (2 lbf/in ) per  
week, the cause should be investigated  
and rectified.  
2
The following procedure should be used  
to check and adjust the tire pressures  
when cold:  
Note: It is an offence in certain countries  
to drive a vehicle with tires that are not  
inflated in accordance with the vehicle’s  
proper use.  
1. Remove the valve cover.  
2. Firmly attach a tire pressure gauge or  
inflator to the valve.  
3. Read the tire pressure from the  
gauge. If required, add air to the tire.  
4. If air is added to the tire, remove the  
gauge from the valve and re-attach it  
before checking that the pressure is  
correct. Failure to remove and  
re-attach the gauge could cause the  
gauge to show an incorrect reading.  
5. If too much air is added, remove the  
gauge from the valve and allow air out  
of the tire by pressing the centre of the  
valve. Reconnect the gauge to the  
valve, and check that the air pressure  
is correct.  
6. Refit the valve cover.  
258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Ambient temperature pressure  
compensation  
Note: Ensure that correct tire pressures  
are maintained when moving to areas of  
differing ambient temperature.  
If the intended journey will take the vehicle  
into an area where the ambient local  
temperature is known to be lower than the  
journey start point, tire pressure under  
inflation could occur.  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring system  
(TPMS) may issue a warning if the under  
inflation becomes significant. When  
driving through variable climatic  
conditions the TPMS warnings may be  
intermittent.  
In areas of extended high ambient  
temperature, vehicle tires can be affected  
by a softening of the tire side wall. If the  
vehicle is stationary for long periods, the  
effect is to slightly deform the tire at the  
point where the tire meets the standing  
surface. This is known as a flat spot.  
JAG0480G  
A colder ambient local temperature will  
reduce pressure within the tire. An effect  
is to decrease sidewall height and to  
increase tire shoulder wear with the  
potential for tire failure. Vehicle dynamics  
could also be adversely affected.  
In order to minimise this effect, tire  
pressures can be adjusted to  
compensate before the start of the  
journey. Alternatively, tire pressures can  
be adjusted when the area of lower  
ambient temperature is reached.  
JAG0481G  
This is normal tire behaviour, however,  
when the vehicle is subsequently driven  
vibration may be experienced from the flat  
spot. The condition will steadily improve  
with additional mileage.  
In this situation the vehicle must be left in  
the ambient local temperature for a least  
one hour before tire pressure is adjusted.  
To compensate for colder ambient  
temperatures, tire pressures should be  
In order to minimise this effect, tire  
pressures can be adjusted to  
compensate.  
2
increased by 0.14 bar (2 lbf/in , 14 kPa)  
for each 10°C (20°F) decrease.  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
For each 10°C (20°F) increase in  
temperature above 20°C (68°F), tire  
pressure should be increased by 14 kPa  
2
(2 lbf/in ).  
Tire pressure compensation chart -  
high ambient temperatures  
Tire Pressure Temperature  
Compensation  
Ambient  
Pressure  
Temperature  
Compensation  
0
0
2
C ( F)  
bar (lbf/in /kPa)  
20 (68)  
30 (86)  
40 (104)  
50 (122)  
use placard label  
+ 0.14 (2 / 14)  
+ 0.28 (4 / 28)  
+ 0.41 (6 / 41)  
260  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Tire Markings  
4
5
3
6
7
2
8
1
9
15  
14  
10  
13  
11  
12  
JAG0395N  
P, 1  
R, 4  
The P indicates the tire is for passenger  
vehicles.  
The R stands for radial. Radial ply  
construction of tires has been the industry  
standard for the past 20 years.  
Tire width, 2  
Wheel diameter, 5  
This three-digit number gives the width in  
millimetres of the tire from sidewall edge  
to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the  
number, the wider the tire.  
This two-digit number is the wheel or rim  
diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new  
tires to match the new wheel diameter.  
Aspect ratio, 3  
Load index, 6  
This two-digit number, known as the  
aspect ratio, gives the tire's ratio of height  
to width (this is also known as the tire  
profile). The lower the number, the shorter  
the tire’s sidewall.  
This two- or three-digit number is the  
tire's load index. It is a measurement of  
how much weight each tire can support.  
Note: You may not find this information  
on all tires because it is not required by  
law.  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Speed rating, 7  
U.S DOT Tire Identification Number  
(TIN), 8  
The speed rating denotes the speed at  
which a tire is designed to be driven for  
extended periods of time. The ratings  
range from 99 mph to 186 mph. These  
ratings are listed in the following table.  
This begins with the letters DOT and  
indicates that the tire meets all federal  
standards. The next two numbers or  
letters are the plant code where it was  
manufactured, and the last four numbers  
represent the week and year the tire was  
built. For example, the numbers 3197  
means the 31st week of 1997. The other  
numbers are marketing codes used at the  
manufacturer's discretion. This  
Note: You may not find this information  
on all tires because it is not required by  
law.  
Letter Rating  
Speed Rating  
99 mph  
Q
R
S
T
U
H
V
information can be used to contact  
consumers if a tire defect requires a  
recall.  
106 mph  
112 mph  
118 mph  
124 mph  
130 mph  
149 mph  
168 mph  
186 mph*  
M+S and all season icon, 9  
The M+S or M/S indicates that the tire  
has some mud and snow capability. Most  
radial tires have these markings.  
W
Y
* For tires with a maximum speed  
capability over 149 mph, tire  
manufacturers sometimes use the  
letters ZR. For those with a maximum  
speed capability over 186 mph, tire  
manufacturers always use the letters  
ZR.  
Tires with all season icon have a level of  
winter performance.  
Tire ply composition and materials  
used, 10  
The number of plies indicates the number  
of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the  
tire. In general, the greater the number of  
plies, the more weight a tire can support.  
Tire manufacturers also must indicate the  
materials in the tire, which include steel,  
nylon, polyester, and others.  
262  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Treadwear number, 11  
Tire pressures during long term vehicle  
storage  
This number indicates the tire's wear rate.  
The higher the treadwear number is, the  
longer it should take for the tread to wear  
down. For example, a tire graded 400  
should last twice as long as a tire graded  
200.  
To minimise the possibility and effects of  
flat spots during storage, the tires may be  
inflated to the maximum pressure  
indicated on the tire sidewall.  
Note: Before using the stored vehicle on  
the road again, ensure that correct tire  
pressures are restored.  
Traction letter, 12  
This letter indicates a tire's ability to stop  
on wet pavement. A higher graded tire  
should allow you to stop your car on wet  
roads in a shorter distance than a tire with  
a lower grade. Traction is graded from  
highest to lowest as AA, A, B, and C.  
Wear  
Maximum load rating, 13  
JAG0393G  
This number indicates the maximum load  
in kilograms and pounds that can be  
carried by the tire.  
All tires fitted as original equipment  
include Tread Wear Indicators (TWI) in  
their tread pattern.  
Temperature letter, 14  
When the tread has worn to a remaining  
depth of 1.6 mm the indicators appear at  
the surface as bars which connect the  
tread pattern across the full width of the  
tire.  
This letter indicates a tire's resistance to  
heat. The temperature grade is for a tire  
that is inflated properly and not  
overloaded. Excessive speed,  
underinflation or excessive loading, either  
separately or in combination, can cause  
heat build-up and possible tire failure.  
From highest to lowest, a tire's resistance  
to heat is graded as A, B, or C.  
It is illegal, in certain countries, to  
continue to use tires after the tread has  
worn to less than 1.6 mm over three  
quarters of the width and the entire  
circumference of the tire.  
Maximum permissible inflation  
pressure, 15  
It should be noted that the properties of  
many tires alter progressively with wear.  
In particular the wet grip and aquaplaning  
resistance are gradually but substantially  
reduced. Extra care and speed restriction  
should therefore be exercised on wet  
roads as the effective tread depth  
diminishes.  
This number is the greatest amount of air  
pressure that should ever be put in the tire  
under normal driving conditions.  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Incorrect wheel alignment will accelerate  
Tire replacement  
tire wear. If there is wear on the inner or  
outer edges of the tread pattern it will be  
advantageous to have the cause detected  
by having the wheel alignment checked.  
When replacing tires, it is preferable to fit  
a complete vehicle set. If either front or  
rear tires only need to be renewed, new  
tires must be fitted as axle sets.  
Do not interchange tires from side to side,  
front to rear or vice versa.  
After new tires have been fitted the  
wheels need to be dynamically balanced.  
Note:  
Do not fit tires with a different tread  
pattern, size or speed rating.  
1. On all models the rear wheel and tire  
assemblies are larger than the front.  
These larger assemblies must never  
be fitted to the front of the vehicle.  
The installation of replacement tires with  
steel cord body plies in the tire sidewall  
may cause malfunction of the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) and  
is not recommended (cord material  
information is moulded on the tire  
sidewall).  
2. On certain models the tires may be  
directional type. These tires must be  
fitted so that when viewed from the  
side of the vehicle, direction of  
rotation arrow, on the tire wall, points  
in the vehicle forward direction of  
travel when positioned at the top of  
the tire.  
Additionally, if your vehicle was equipped  
with run-flat tires, replacing them with  
tires that are not identical to those  
originally fitted may cause malfunction of  
the TPMS, and is not recommended.  
Damage  
Always check your TPMS indicator after  
replacing one or more tires on your  
vehicle. See TPMS, page 267.  
Caution: Do not use paraffin  
(kerosene), because this has a  
detrimental effect on rubber.  
Tire ageing  
Excessive local distortion can cause the  
casing of a tire to fracture and may lead to  
premature failure. Tires should be  
examined especially for cracked walls,  
exposed cords, etc. Flints and other  
sharp objects must be removed from the  
tire tread; if left in they may work through  
the cover. Clean off any oil or grease  
contamination by using a suitable cleaner.  
!
WARNING:  
Tires degrade over time, even when  
they are not being used. It is  
recommended that tires generally be  
replaced after six years of normal  
service. Heat caused by hot climates or  
frequent high loading conditions can  
accelerate the ageing process.  
Tire repair  
Damaged tires should be replaced with  
new tires fitted. They must not be repaired  
in view of the high performance capability  
of the vehicle.  
You should replace the spare tire when  
you replace the other road tires due to  
the ageing of the spare tire.  
264  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
USING WINTER TIRES  
USING SNOW CHAINS  
Winter tires are more suitable during  
extremes of low temperatures, snow and  
ice and will considerably improve the  
vehicle’s handling during these  
conditions.  
!
WARNING:  
Trac DSC must be switched ON when  
using snow chains. DSC would reduce  
the deep snow traction capability as it  
would limit wheel spin to a level below  
that which is required to generate  
maximum traction.  
Do not exceed 240 km/h (150 mph) when  
using Jaguar approved winter tires.  
Winter tires must be fitted on all four  
wheels.  
Caution: Do not fit snow chains to  
20 inch tires.  
Approved Winter tire sizes  
Snow chains, of the recommended type,  
can only be fitted to rear wheels. They  
should not be used on temporary use  
spare wheels.  
Front: 245/45R18, Dunlop Wintersport  
M3 96V.  
Rear: 265/40R18, Dunlop Wintersport M3  
97V.  
You should contact your Jaguar Dealer  
for details and availability of approved  
snow chains.  
Winter tire pressures:  
Up to 240 km/h (150 mph)  
The maximum speed when using snow  
chains is 48 km/h (30 mph).  
2
Front  
2.0 bar (30 lbf/in , 207 ka)  
(245)  
Rear  
(265)  
Remove the snow chains immediately the  
roads are clear of snow.  
2
2.3 bar (33 lbf/in , 230 kPa)  
Ensure the fitting instructions supplied  
with the snow chains are kept in a safe  
place, for example, with this literature  
pack.  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS  
Recommended tire fitment  
The following chart details the tires recommended for use in USA, Canada, Mexico and  
the Dominican Republic:  
Tire size  
245/45ZR18 100Z  
275/40ZR18 103Z  
Pattern  
Front  
Rear  
Continental Sport Contact 2 Asymmetric  
Continental Sport Contact 2 Asymmetric  
Front  
Rear  
245/40ZR19 94Y  
275/35ZR19 96Y  
Dunlop Sport 01 Asymmetric  
Dunlop Sport 01 Asymmetric  
Front  
Rear  
255/35ZR20 97Y  
285/30ZR20 99Y  
Dunlop Sportmaxx Directional  
Dunlop Sportmaxx Directional  
19 inch Run-flat  
Front  
Rear  
245/40R19 RSC 94Y  
275/35R19 RSC 96Y  
Dunlop Sport 01 DSST  
Dunlop Sport 01 DSST  
Temporary use spare wheel  
Front and Rear:  
Alloy 4 x 18  
T135/80 R18  
Pirelli  
For all other countries refer to your local Jaguar Dealer for specific tire fitment.  
266  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING  
SYSTEM (TPMS)  
1
!
WARNING:  
The TPMS is not a substitute for  
manually checking tire pressures.  
Tire pressures should be checked  
regularly using an accurate  
pressure gauge when cold. Failure  
to properly maintain your tire  
pressures could increase the risk of  
tire failure, with consequential loss  
of vehicle control and personal  
injury.  
2
The TPMS cannot register damage  
to a tire. Regularly check the  
JAG0389G  
Wheels fitted with a TPMS can be easily  
visually identified by the external metal  
lock nut and valve 1. All Jaguar  
non-TPMS wheels have a rubber valve  
fitted 2.  
condition of your tires, especially if  
the vehicle is driven off road.  
Note:  
1. Non-approved accessories may  
interfere with the system. If this  
occurs, TIRE PRESSURE SYSTEM  
FAULT is displayed in the message  
centre.  
TPMS operation  
The TPMS monitors the pressure of the  
tires via sensors located in each wheel  
and a receiver located within the vehicle.  
Communication between sensor and  
receiver is via Radio Frequency (RF)  
signals.  
2. Tires may affect the performance of  
the TPMS. Always replace tires in  
accordance with recommendations,  
see page 266.  
The tire pressure warning  
comprises a yellow warning  
telltale within the instrument  
cluster and an associated message within  
the message centre.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a  
TPMS which monitors pressure in each  
tire (temporary use spare tires are not  
fitted with sensors and are consequently  
not monitored).  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Please note that the TPMS is not a  
substitute for proper tire maintenance,  
and it is the driver’s responsibility to  
maintain correct tire pressure, even if  
under-inflation has not reached the level  
to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire  
pressure telltale.  
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE  
AVE EL  
The TPMS may issue a warning if the  
under inflation becomes significant. When  
driving through variable climatic  
conditions the TPMS warnings may be  
intermittent.  
A
MPG  
JAG0060NAS  
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),  
should be checked monthly when cold  
and inflated to the inflation pressure  
recommended by the vehicle  
manufacturer on the vehicle placard or  
tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle  
has tires of a different size than the size  
indicated on the vehicle placard or tire  
inflation pressure label, you should  
determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires).  
Caution: When inflating tires, care  
should be taken to avoid bending or  
damage to the TPMS valves. Always  
ensure correct alignment of the  
inflation head to the valve stem.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with  
a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate  
when the system is not operating  
properly.  
The TPMS malfunction indicator is  
combined with the low tire pressure  
telltale. When the system detects a  
malfunction, the telltale will flash for  
approximately one minute and then  
remain continuously illuminated. This  
sequence will continue upon subsequent  
vehicle start-ups as long as the  
malfunction exists  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle  
has been equipped with a tire pressure  
monitoring system (TPMS) that  
illuminates a low tire pressure telltale  
when one or more of your tires is  
significantly under-inflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure  
telltale illuminates, you should stop and  
check your tires as soon as possible, and  
inflate them to the proper pressure.  
Driving on a significantly under-inflated  
tire causes the tire to overheat and can  
lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also  
reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life,  
and may affect the vehicle’s handling and  
stopping ability.  
When the malfunction indicator is  
illuminated, the system may not be able to  
detect or signal low tire pressure as  
intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur  
for a variety of reasons, including the  
installation of replacement or alternate  
tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent  
the TPMS from functioning properly.  
268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Always check the TPMS malfunction  
If a tire needs to be changed  
telltale after replacing one or more tires or  
wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the  
replacement or alternate tires and wheels  
allow the TPMS to continue to function  
properly.  
It is recommended that you should always  
have your tires serviced by a Jaguar  
Dealer.  
If a TPMS is fitted, each wheel and tire  
assembly, with the exception of a  
temporary use spare is equipped with a  
tire pressure sensor connected to the tire  
valve stem.  
A supplementary text message will  
accompany the system indicator and will  
display TIRE PRESSURE SYSTEM  
FAULT.  
In order to avoid damage to the sensor  
the tires must be removed and refitted to  
the road wheel in a specific manner. Care  
must be taken to avoid contact between  
the bead of the tire and the sensor during  
removal and refitting of the tire, otherwise  
the sensor may become damaged and or  
inoperable.  
Temporary use spare wheel and tire  
change  
Should it be necessary to change a wheel  
and tire with the temporary use spare,  
then the system will automatically  
recognise the change in wheel positions.  
Then after approximately ten minutes of  
driving above 25 km/h (18 mph) , a text  
message TIRE NOT MONITORED will be  
displayed accompanied by illumination of  
the warning telltale and the corresponding  
block in the vehicle graphic.  
Caution: Valve stem seal, washer, nut,  
valve core and cap should be replaced  
at every tire change. Valve stem seal,  
washer and nut must be replaced if  
valve retention nut is loosened. Sensor  
units and nuts must be refitted using  
correct torques and associated torque  
profile. Damage to the vehicle may  
result if these precautions are not  
taken.  
The warning telltale will initially flash and  
will subsequently revert to continuous  
illumination. Extended use of the  
temporary use spare wheel will produce  
an additional text message TIRE  
PRESSURE SYSTEM FAULT.  
Sensors can be removed from the wheel  
by the unscrewing of the valve retention  
nut.  
The TPMS display sequence will be  
activated at every ignition cycle until the  
temporary use spare wheel is replaced by  
a fully operational full size wheel and tire  
assembly.  
Replacement sensor fitment  
procedure  
A replacement sensor must be fitted to a  
running wheel in order to be recognised  
by the system. Recognition only occurs  
when the vehicle is driven above 25 km/h  
(18 mph) for approximately ten minutes.  
Always replace the temporary use spare  
wheel before having TPMS faults  
investigated. The fault may well be  
rectified with the fitment of a fully  
operational full size running tire in lieu of  
the temporary use wheel and tire  
assembly.  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Should the TPMS warning for any wheel  
not clear, even after ensuring correct  
inflation pressures and driving for more  
than ten minutes above 25 km/h (18 mph),  
contact your Jaguar Dealer.  
TPMS information messages  
Message  
Warning  
Light  
TPMS  
Priority  
Indicator  
Amber  
Meaning  
CHECK TIRE  
PRESSURE  
You should as soon as possible  
stop, check your tire and inflate  
them to the recommended  
pressure.  
(Graphic indication  
displays which tire is  
under inflated.)  
CHECK ALL TIRE  
PRESSURES  
TPMS  
Amber  
One or more tire is significantly  
under-inflated. You stop as soon  
as possible, check your tires and  
inflate them to the recommended  
pressure. This message may be  
displayed when the vehicle is  
learning a new sensor to vehicle  
and one or more tires has low  
pressure.  
TIRE PRESSURE  
SYSTEM FAULT  
TPMS  
Amber  
1. You have fitted wheels and  
tires which do not have TPMS  
sensors. You should as soon as  
possible have TPMS sensors  
fitted to wheels and tires.  
2. TPMS sensors have become  
defective, an unapproved  
accessory is interfering with the  
TPMS or a general fault has been  
detected in the TPMS. Contact a  
Jaguar Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
270  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
TPMS information messages  
Message  
Warning  
Light  
Priority  
Indicator  
Amber  
Meaning  
TIRE NOT MONITORED TPMS  
(Graphic indication  
displays which tire is not  
monitored.)  
1. You have a temporary use  
spare wheel fitted at the  
corresponding position.  
You should limit your vehicle  
speed to 80 km/h (50 mph)  
and as soon as possible  
replace the temporary use  
spare wheel with a correctly  
inflated full size tire.  
2. The TPMS sensor, at the  
corresponding position, has  
become defective, an  
unapproved accessory is  
interfering with the TPMS or  
you have fitted a wheel and  
tire which does not have a  
sensor. Contact a Jaguar  
Dealer as soon as possible.  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Caution: Ultra high performance tires.  
WHEEL CHANGING  
This vehicle is equipped with an Ultra  
High Performance (UHP) tire and wheel  
combination designed to give  
maximum dry road performance with  
consideration for aquaplaning  
!
WARNING:  
Always ensure replacement tires  
have the correct rating and  
specifications (e.g. load index, size,  
speed rating) for your vehicle.  
resistance. UHP tires have  
performance enhancing soft rubber  
tread compound. If driven aggressively  
they may suffer rapid tread wear and a  
shorter life than can be expected from  
other tire types. This wheel and tire  
combination is more susceptible to  
damage from road hazards.  
When using tires other than those  
recommended by Jaguar, do not  
exceed the speed capacity  
recommended by the  
manufacturer.  
Wheels are extremely heavy. Take  
care when lifting and particularly  
when removing and replacing a  
wheel in its storage position in the  
luggage compartment.  
Do not use this combination for driving  
on snow or ice. High perfromance tires  
must be replaced with winter tires  
when weather conditions dictate.  
If a wheel change is required, pull off the  
road completely. Park on ground which is  
as level and solid as possible. Ensure that  
the vehicle is clear of any objects that will  
obstruct the safe removal of the wheel.  
Switch on hazard warning lights and,  
where legally required, display the  
warning triangle.  
Temporary use spare wheel  
IMPORTANT - USE OF SPARE TIRE  
Observe the following warnings before  
using the wheel:  
!
WARNING:  
Please note temporary use spare  
wheel warning label. Adhere to  
instructions on the label. Failure to  
comply can be dangerous.  
Regular maintenance of tires contributes  
not only to safety, but to the designed  
function of the vehicle. Road-holding,  
steering and braking are especially  
vulnerable to incorrectly pressurised,  
badly fitted or worn tires.  
When a temporary use spare wheel  
is fitted, drive with caution and  
replace with the specified wheel  
and tire as soon as possible.  
Tires of the correct size and type, but of  
different make can varying  
characteristics. It is therefore  
recommended that Jaguar approved tires  
are fitted to all wheels.  
Do not fit more than one temporary  
use spare wheel and tire assembly  
at one time.  
The temporary use spare wheel  
must be inflated to 4.2 bar (60 lb/in ,  
2
420 kPa) and cannot be repaired.  
272  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Temporary use spare wheel,  
maximum speed is 80 km/h  
(50 mph).  
If the vehicle is fully laden with  
passengers and luggage, the maximum  
distance that can be completed on a fully  
deflated tire is approximately  
If the vehicle is fitted with Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS) refer to page 267.  
80 kilometres (50 miles).  
Stop immediately if the tire construction  
begins to break down, or if the tire  
dislodges from the wheel rim. Typically,  
this will be accompanied with excessive  
vibration.  
DSC must be ON when the  
temporary use spare wheel is in  
use.  
Run-flat tires  
A tire driven in a deflated condition it must  
be replaced.  
!
WARNING:  
Vehicles fitted with run-flat tires are not  
fitted with a spare wheel or jacking  
equipment. Therefore, run-flat tires  
should be replaced with the same type of  
tire.  
If a run-flat is deflated maximum  
vehicle speed must not exceed 80 km/h  
(50 mph).  
JAG0384G  
Run-flat tires can be identified by the  
lettering RSC on the sidewall. The tire  
construction utilises a specially reinforced  
sidewall which allows the vehicle to be  
driven at restricted speeds even when the  
tire is depressurised. Run-flat tires can  
only be fitted to special rims constructed  
for run-flat tire use.  
A tire pressure monitoring system is  
mandatory when the vehicle is fitted with  
run-flat tires, see page 267.  
If the tire in a deflated the vehicle should  
be driven with caution, as handling  
characteristics will be different compared  
to a fully inflated tire.  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Locking wheel nuts  
Spare wheel location  
Vehicles may be equipped with a locking  
wheel nut on each wheel. These are  
similar to standard wheel nuts, and can  
only be removed using the special  
adaptor provided with the jacking  
equipment.  
The spare wheel and jacking equipment  
are stored under the luggage  
compartment floor panel.  
JAG0561G  
1. Insert the adaptor firmly onto the  
JAG0386G  
locking wheel nut.  
To remove the spare wheel, remove the  
luggage compartment floor panel and the  
tray containing the jacking equipment.  
Unscrew the spare wheel retaining Tee  
bolt and remove the spare wheel.  
2. Using the wheel brace, unscrew the  
wheel nut and adaptor.  
3. Return the locking wheel nut adaptor  
to the correct storage position.  
Note: A code number is stamped on the  
side of the locking nut. Ensure the number  
is recorded on the Security Card supplied  
with the literature pack. Quote this  
number if a replacement is required. Do  
not keep the Security Card in the vehicle.  
Remove the jack and wheel nut wrench  
from the stowage tray.  
Note: Examine the jack occasionally and  
clean and grease the threads to ensure it  
is always ready for an emergency.  
274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Wheel changing procedure  
!
WARNING:  
Before attempting to lift the vehicle  
with the jack, chock the wheel  
diagonally opposite to the wheel  
being replaced to prevent the  
vehicle from rolling when jacked  
up. A wheel chock is supplied with  
the jacking equipment for this  
purpose.  
Never work under the vehicle using  
only the jack as a support, always  
use axle stands or suitable  
supports under the jacking points.  
Note: When one rear wheel is lifted off the  
ground the selection P (Park) position will  
not prevent the vehicle from moving and  
possibly slipping off the jack as the  
parkbrake only operates on the rear  
wheels.  
JAG0387G  
There are four jacking points on the  
underside of the floor. Two indented,  
triangular indicators are provided on each  
sill cover. These indicate the location for  
the jack.  
1. Ensure that all passengers are in a  
safe place, clear of the vehicle.  
The simplest way to correctly locate the  
jacking point is to feel along the sill panel  
to the triangular indentation and then fit  
the jack to the body, not to the sill panel.  
2. Apply the parkbrake and select gear  
position P (Park).  
3. Ensure that the jack is placed on firm  
and level ground.  
Observe the instructions printed on the  
jack.  
Use the jack only for lifting the vehicle  
during wheel changing and only use the  
jack which is stored in the vehicle.  
Before raising the vehicle slacken but do  
not remove the wheel nuts.  
Do not start or run the engine while the  
vehicle is supported only by a jack.  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Raising the vehicle  
Tightening the wheel nuts  
!
WARNING:  
1
3
Do not attempt to lift the vehicle  
unless the jack head is fully  
engaged in the jacking point.  
Ensure that the parkbrake is  
applied.  
4
5
Caution: Ensure before raising the  
vehicle that the jack is correctly  
positioned to avoid any damage to the  
vehicle sills or sill panels.  
2
JAG0388G  
Lower the jack and tighten the wheel nuts  
alternately, Do not over tighten by using  
foot pressure or extension bars on the  
wheel nut wrench.  
Carefully raise the vehicle by turning the  
jack handle. Stop jacking the vehicle  
when the tire just clears the ground.  
Minimum tire lift gives maximum vehicle  
stability.  
At the earliest opportunity have the wheel  
nuts tightened with a torque wrench to  
125 Nm (92 lb.ft).  
Remove the wheel nuts and the wheel.  
To remove the centre badge use the  
plastic tipped end of the wheel nut  
wrench handle, push the centre badge  
from its housing from the inside of the  
wheel.  
This torque must not be exceeded.  
Stowing the equipment  
Place the storage tray with the jack and  
wrench in the wheel well.  
Reposition the luggage compartment  
floor panel.  
Push the centre badge into the  
replacement wheel. If the temporary use  
spare wheel is to be fitted, keep the  
centre badge safely and fit it to the  
repaired full size wheel when it has been  
refitted.  
Place the removed road wheel in the  
luggage compartment. The full size road  
wheel will not be able to be completely  
stowed in the wheel well.  
Fit the spare wheel and loosely secure  
with the wheel nuts.  
Caution: Convertible only. The luggage  
separator will required to be removed  
before stowing the wheel in the  
Using the wheel nut wrench, lightly  
tighten the wheel nuts alternately using  
the sequence shown in the illustration.  
luggage compartment, see page 151.  
276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT  
!
OF TRANSPORTATION/  
UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY  
GRADES  
WARNING:  
The traction grade assigned to this tire  
is based on straight-ahead braking  
traction tests and does not include  
cornering (turning) traction tests and  
does not include acceleration,  
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak  
traction characteristics.  
The following information relates to the  
tire grading system developed by the  
National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration which will grade tires by  
tread wear, traction and temperature  
performance.  
Temperature – A, B, C  
The temperature grades are A  
Tread wear  
(the highest), B and C representing the  
tire’s resistance to the generation of heat  
and its ability to dissipate heat when  
tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
The tread wear grade is a comparative  
rating based on the wear rate of the tire  
when tested under controlled conditions  
on a specified government test course.  
For example, a tire graded 150 would  
wear one and a half (1.5) times as well on  
the government course as a tire  
Sustained high temperature can cause  
the material of the tire to degenerate and  
reduce tire life, and excessive  
temperature can lead to sudden tire  
failure.  
graded 100.  
The relative performance of tires depends  
upon the actual conditions of their use,  
however, and may depart significantly  
from the norm due to variations in driving  
habits, service practices and differences  
in road characteristics and climate.  
The grade C corresponds to a level of  
performance which all passenger car tires  
must meet under the Federal Motor  
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109.  
Grades B and A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory test wheel  
than the minimum required by law.  
Traction  
The traction grades, from the highest to  
the lowest are AA, A, B and C. The  
grades represent the tire’s ability to stop  
on wet pavement as measured under  
controlled conditions on specified  
government test surfaces of asphalt and  
concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
!
WARNING:  
The temperature grade for this tire is  
established for a tire that is properly  
inflated and not over loaded. Excessive  
speed, under-inflation or excessive  
loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat build-up  
and possible tire failure.  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Maximum loaded vehicle weight:  
This is the sum of:  
TIRE GLOSSARY  
Cold tire pressure:  
Curb weight.  
Pressure in a tire that has been driven for  
less than one mile or has been standing  
for three hours or more.  
Accessory weight.  
Vehicle capacity weight.  
Production options weight.  
Maximum inflation pressure:  
Maximum air pressure, to which a cold  
tire may be inflated, this figure (in kPa and  
psi) is moulded onto the sidewall of a tire.  
Rim:  
A metal support for a tire or a tire and tube  
assembly upon which the tire beads are  
seated.  
Curb weight:  
The weight of a motor vehicle with  
standard equipment including the  
maximum capacity of fuel, oil, coolant  
and if so equipped, air conditioning and  
additional weight optional engine.  
Bead:  
The part of the tire that is made of steel  
wires, wrapped or reinforced by ply cords  
and that is shaped to fit the rim.  
Accessory weight:  
The combined weight (in excess of those  
standard items which may be replaced) of  
automatic transmission, power steering,  
power brakes, power windows, power  
seats, radio and heater, to the extent that  
these items are available as  
factory-installed equipment (whether  
installed or not).  
Production options weight:  
The combined weight of those installed  
production options weighing over 1.4 kg  
(3 lb) in excess of those standard items  
which they replace, not previously  
considered in curb weight or accessory  
weight, including heavy duty brakes, ride  
levellers, roof rack, heavy duty battery  
and special trim.  
Vehicle capacity weight:  
The rated cargo and luggage load plus  
68.0 kg (150.0 lb) times the vehicle’s  
designated seating capacity.  
278  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
PRODUCTION OPTIONS  
WEIGHTS  
!
WARNING:  
Do not exceed the weight limits  
specified on the TIRE LOADING  
INFORMATION label (see page 257).  
(USA only)  
This table lists the production options  
weights. To calculate the curbweight of  
your vehicle, add the weight of all  
production options, including optional  
alloy wheels and spare wheel, to the basic  
curbweight for your vehicle.  
To calculate the cargo and luggage load  
capacity of your vehicle, refer to page  
280.  
Note: The table only lists optional  
equipment that weigh more than 3.0 lb  
(1.4 kg).  
Weight  
lb  
kg  
Curb weight, no options fitted  
See Technical Specification Weight Tables pages 283 and 284.  
Production options  
Jaguar Premium Surround Sound System  
Sirius Satellite Radio  
Navigation  
16 way luxury sport seats  
Adaptive Front Lighting System  
13.23  
2.87  
4.9  
7.72  
3.31  
6.0  
1.3  
2.2  
3.5  
1.5  
Wheels and tires  
18 inch wheels (Venus)  
0
0
19 inch wheels (Carelia)  
16.54  
18.96  
26.46  
- 4.0  
7.5  
8.6  
12.0  
- 8.82  
20 inch wheels (Senta), supercharged available  
20 inch wheels (Senta), normally aspirated, if available  
19 inch Run-flat tires (Sabre) deletes Temporary use spare wheel,  
supercharged.  
19 inch Run-flat tires (Sabre) deletes Temporary use spare wheel,  
normally aspirated.  
- 5.51 - 2.5  
Note:  
The weights listed under Wheels and tires give the increase in weight over a standard  
set of four wheels: the figure only needs to be added to the curbweight once. The Spare  
wheel and tire weight must also be added, where applicable.  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wheels and Tires  
Steps for determining correct load limit  
The number and weight of passengers will  
affect the cargo and luggage load  
capacity. In the example above, the cargo  
and luggage load capacity is 650 lb.  
However, if fewer passengers ride in the  
vehicle, the luggage load capacity will  
increase. If this vehicle carries three  
150 lb passengers, the cargo and luggage  
load capacity will increase to 950 lb:  
(3 x 150 = 450 lb, and  
!
WARNING:  
Do not exceed the vehicle capacity  
weight (the total weight of driver,  
passengers and cargo) given on the  
tire information label (see page 257).  
1. Locate the statement, The combined  
weight of occupants and cargo  
should never exceed XXXX kg or  
XXXX lb on your vehicle’s placard (see  
page 257).  
1400 - 450 = 950 lb).  
If the passengers weigh more, the cargo  
and luggage load capacity will decrease.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the  
driver and passengers that will be  
riding in your vehicle.  
!
WARNING:  
The weight of accessories must  
also be subtracted from the  
available cargo and luggage load  
capacity. If you are unsure of the  
weight of any accessories fitted to  
your vehicle, contact your Jaguar  
Dealer.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the  
driver and passengers from XXXX kg  
or XXXX lb (weight given on placard).  
4. The resulting figure equals the  
available amount of cargo and  
luggage load capacity. For example, if  
the XXXX amount equals 1400 lb, and  
there will be five 150 lb passengers in  
your vehicle, the amount of available  
cargo and luggage load capacity is  
650 lb:  
Overloading the vehicle will have an  
adverse affect on braking and  
handling characteristics, which  
could compromise your safety.  
Overloading a vehicle may also  
cause tire damage or failure.  
Never overload your vehicle.  
1400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lb).  
5. Determine the combined weight of  
luggage and cargo being loaded on  
the vehicle. That weight may not  
safely exceed the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity calculated in  
Step 4.  
TOWING: The XK has not been  
designed as a towing vehicle and  
Jaguar Cars does not manufacture  
a tow bar for the vehicle.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer,  
load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult  
this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
280  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Identification  
Chapter  
9
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION  
NUMBER (VIN)  
VEHICLE CERTIFICATION  
LABEL  
It is essential that the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN) is quoted in all  
correspondence and when ordering  
replacement parts.  
JAG0397G  
Vehicles have the Certification Label  
adhered to the left-hand door rear post.  
Vehicle weights, paint code, manufacture  
date and the VIN are shown on this plate.  
ENGINE NUMBER  
JAG0396G  
The number is located on the rear  
left-hand side of the engine below the  
rectangular block.  
The number is visible from outside the  
vehicle, on a plate in the lower left-hand  
edge of the windshield.  
TRANSMISSION NUMBER  
The number is etched on a plinth on the  
side of the transmission casing.  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
Technical Specifications  
ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS  
Engine 4.2 litre V8  
3
3
Capacity  
Stroke  
90.3 mm (3.555 inch)  
4196 cm (255 inch )  
Bore  
86.0 mm (3.385 inch) Compression ratio 11.0:1 (9.1:1 supercharged)  
DIMENSIONS  
D
E
C
B
F
A
G
H
JAG0398G  
A
B
B
C
D
D
Overall width, mirrors extended  
Overall width, mirrors folded  
2070 mm 81.5 in.  
1892 mm 74.5 in.  
Overall width, mirrors folded, rear arch extensions fitted 1912 mm 75.3 in.  
Track: Front (maximum) 1560 mm 61.0 in.  
Overall height at gross vehicle weight (nominal) - Coupe 1287mm 50.6 in.  
1294 mm 51.0 in.  
Overall height at gross vehicle weight (nominal) -  
Convertible  
E
F
G
H
Minimum ground clearance (at gross vehicle weight)  
Track: Rear (maximum)  
Wheelbase  
100 mm  
4.0 in.  
1608 mm 63.3 in.  
2752 mm 108 in.  
4791 mm 187 in.  
Overall length  
Turning circle (curb to curb)  
10.97 m  
36.0 ft.  
282  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
WEIGHTS  
(AVERAGE/APPROXIMATE)  
V8 4.2 litre normally aspirated engine  
Coupe  
Convertible  
kg  
1665  
887  
778  
lb  
kg  
1705  
888  
lb  
Curb weight (no options fitted)  
Front axle Curb weight  
Rear axle Curb weight  
3671  
1956  
1715  
3759  
1958  
1801  
817  
Gross Vehicle Weight (G.V.W.)  
Gross front axle weight  
Gross rear axle weight  
2035  
1015  
1090  
4486  
2238  
2403  
2075  
1020  
1125  
4575  
2249  
2480  
Maximum recommended luggage  
compartment load with passenger  
and driver  
28  
62  
28  
62  
Note: Loads greater than 28 kg (62 lb)  
may be carried in the luggage  
compartment provided the maximum  
technically permissible axle weights  
shown on the vehicle identification plate  
are not exceeded and the tires are inflated  
to the normal pressures.  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
V8 4.2 litre supercharged engine  
Coupe  
Convertible  
kg  
1730  
935  
795  
lb  
kg  
1780  
943  
lb  
Curb weight (no options fitted)  
Front axle Curb weight  
Rear axle Curb weight  
3814  
2061  
1753  
3924  
2079  
1845  
837  
Gross Vehicle Weight (G.V.W.)  
Gross front axle weight  
Gross rear axle weight  
2080  
1050  
1095  
4586  
2315  
2414  
2120  
1050  
1130  
4674  
2315  
2491  
Maximum recommended luggage  
compartment load with passenger  
and driver  
28  
62  
28  
62  
Note: Loads greater than 28 kg (62 lb)  
may be carried in the luggage  
compartment provided the maximum  
technically permissible axle weights  
shown on the vehicle identification plate  
are not exceeded and the tires are inflated  
to the normal pressures.  
284  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Technical Specifications  
CAPACITIES  
V8 4.2 litre normally aspirated engine  
Litres  
Pints  
Engine oil, including oil filter.  
7.0  
14.8  
Cooling system, including reservoir and climate control.  
Windshield and headlamp washer reservoir:  
10.4  
6.3  
22.0  
13.3  
V8 4.2 litre supercharged engine  
Litres  
Pints  
Engine oil, including oil filter.  
7.0  
14.8  
Cooling system, including reservoir and climate control.  
10.0  
6.6  
21.1  
14.0  
Windshield and headlamp washer reservoir:  
Fuel capacity  
Total tank  
71.1 litres  
capacity  
(18.8 Gallons)  
Fill capacity  
(when the fuel  
gauge indicates  
empty)  
65.5 litres  
(17.2 Gallons)  
Reserve capacity 6.0 litres  
(when the fuel  
gauge indicates  
empty)  
(1.6 Gallons)  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Type Approvals  
Type Approvals  
SMART KEY REMOTE  
CONTROL RADIO FREQUENCY  
The radio frequency remote system  
operates on a frequency subject to USA  
Federal Communications Commission  
(FCC) rules.  
DECLARATION OF  
CONFORMITY FOR THE  
TELEPHONE SYSTEM  
Export controls  
This product contains commodities,  
technology or software exported from the  
United States in accordance with the  
Export Administration regulations.  
Diversion contrary to U.S. or Canadian  
law is prohibited.  
The device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC rules and RSS-210 of the Industry  
Canada. Operation is subject to the two  
following conditions:  
The device may not cause harmful  
interference.  
FCC/Industry Canada Notice  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and  
(2) this device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
This device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause  
undesired operation.  
The key transmitter radio frequency  
approval numbers for the USA and  
Canada are shown below:  
USA - CWTWB1U243  
FCC ID: AZ489FT7024  
Canada - 1788A-1U243  
Canada IC: 109U-89FT7024  
Note: The manufacturer is not  
Changes or modifications not expressly  
approved by the party responsible for  
compliance could void the user's  
responsible for any radio interference or  
TV interference caused by unauthorised  
modifications to this equipment. Changes  
or modifications not expressly approved  
by the party responsible for compliance  
could void the user’s authority to operate  
the equipment.  
authority to operate the equipment.  
Note: This equipment has been tested  
and found to comply with the limits for a  
Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15  
of the FCC Rules. These limits are  
designed to provide reasonable  
Caution: The Jaguar Smart Key may  
suffer interference from other legal  
users of this radio frequency band,  
such as radio amateurs, medical  
equipment, remote controls or alarm  
systems. To lock or unlock the vehicle  
in such a situation, either use a key or  
operate the key transmitter as close to  
the security antenna on the front  
screen as possible.  
protection against harmful interference in  
a residential installation.  
286  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Type Approvals  
This equipment generates, uses and can  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING  
SYSTEM (TPMS)  
The TPMS devices comply with part 15 of  
the FCC Rules and RSS-210. Operation is  
subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause  
interference, and (2) this device must  
accept interference received, including  
interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
radiate radio frequency energy and, if not  
installed and used in accordance with the  
instructions, may cause harmful  
interference to radio communications.  
However, there is no guarantee that  
interference will not occur in a particular  
installation.  
If this equipment does cause harmful  
interference to radio or television  
reception, which can be determined by  
turning the equipment off and on, the user  
is encouraged to try to correct the  
interference by one or more of the  
following measures:  
Note: Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the manufacture  
could void the users’ authority to operate  
the equipment.  
The TPMS radio frequency approval  
numbers for the USA and Canada are  
shown below:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving  
antenna.  
Increase the separation between the  
equipment and receiver.  
USA FCC ID: KR5S120123,  
TX KR55WK47594, RX 5WK4887.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet  
on a circuit different from that to which  
the receiver is connected.  
Canada IC: 267T-S120123,  
267T-5WK47594, CAN2671032336A.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced  
radio/TV technician for help.  
DOLBY LICENSING  
Dolby Pro Logic  
Surround and the  
double-D are  
registered trademark  
of Dolby Laboratories. Manufacturing  
rights for Dolby Pro Logic Surround  
System are licensed from Dolby  
Laboratories Licensing Corporation.  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
288  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
A
Automatic transmission . . . . . . . . . . 157  
gear selector positions. . . . . . . . . 157  
gearshift interlock. . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Jaguar sequential shift mode gear  
selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159  
kickdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158  
limp-home mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
Accessory socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
Active headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
Adaptive cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . 172  
forward alert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177  
Adjusting the time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
Advanced restraint technology system  
(ARTS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95  
components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98  
Air bags  
system fault display . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
B
Battery  
disposal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
front. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99  
labels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99  
occupancy sensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
warning lamp. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137  
Alarms and audible signals . . . . . . . . . 49  
Anti-lock braking system (ABS). . . . . 162  
Audible warnings and indicators. . . . 116  
Audio system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182  
auto memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189  
automatic volume control . . . . . . . 190  
band switching . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186  
care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183  
CD operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196  
compact disc player . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Dolby licensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287  
load a CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195  
MP3 CDs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198  
premium sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190  
preset stations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190  
programme type (PTY) . . . . . . . . . 188  
radio text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186  
RDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192  
recordable CDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
seek tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189  
settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187  
unload a CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195  
use. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
Autolamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
windshield wiper detection . . . . . . . 72  
Automatic speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . 180  
charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245  
disconnection effects. . . . . . . . . . 246  
maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243  
using booster cables . . . . . . . . . . 243  
warning signs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242  
Bi-Xenon headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
Booster seats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
Brake fluid check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
ABS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
emergency brake assist. . . . . . . . 163  
Bulbs  
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77  
C
Catalytic converters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54  
Checking and top up  
brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240  
coolant level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237  
power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . 241  
windshield/headlamp washer . . . 239  
Child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103  
booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103  
choosing a child seat. . . . . . . . . . 104  
fitting the child seat . . . . . . . . . . . 105  
infant safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104  
LATCH seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
restraint check list . . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
top tether anchorages . . . . . . . . . 106  
Climate control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
air distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134  
Clock adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Computer active technology system  
Exterior lighting  
(CATS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Convenience mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
Convertible top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147  
care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227  
closing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152  
luggage separator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150  
deploy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151  
install. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152  
normal stowage. . . . . . . . . . . . . 150  
remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151  
manual re-set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148  
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147  
winter conditions. . . . . . . . . . 150, 228  
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169  
daylight running lamps. . . . . . . . . . 73  
exit delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
touring adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . . 76  
Exterior mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89  
F
Facia and controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109  
Fire extinguisher. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
fitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
First aid kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
Floor mat retention. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
Forward alert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177  
Front seat heaters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Fuel and refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
refuelling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
system fault display . . . . . . . . . . . . 53  
Fuel capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285  
Fuel requirements  
information messages. . . . . . . . . . 171  
D
Dimmer switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
Driving after a collision . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Driving hints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
running-in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Driving position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Dynamic stability control. . . . . . . . . . 165  
switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
gasoline engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53  
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247  
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247  
checking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247  
fuse box locations . . . . . . . . . . . . 248  
switching on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
specification chart . . . . . . . . . . . . 252  
E
G
Electric park brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Electrical accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31  
Emergency brake assist . . . . . . . . . . 163  
Engine  
Garage door transceiver . . . . . . . . . 143  
before programming . . . . . . . . . . 144  
information and assistance . . . . . 146  
programming the vehicle . . . . . . . 144  
Gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
General driving information  
coolant check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238  
keyless start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
oil check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237  
oil consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237  
rolling re-start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
starting and stopping . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
stationary vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158  
stopping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Engine compartment. . . . . . . . . . . . . 235  
Engine number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281  
Engine oil. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237  
Environmental information . . . . . . . . 232  
Event data recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
engine oil consumption . . . . . . . . . 56  
running-in. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Ground points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
H
Hazard warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76  
Headlamp powerwash. . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Health and safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
Heated seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Hood release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63  
I
Identification numbers  
vehicle identification number. . . . 281  
Inertia switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
290  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
L
Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111  
Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
auto headlamp levelling . . . . . . . . . 76  
autolamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
battery saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
bulb replacement  
dimmer switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111  
message centre. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111  
speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111  
tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111  
Interior features  
cornering lamp. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
front direction indicator . . . . . . . 80  
front sidelamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80  
headlamp assembly. . . . . . . . . . 77  
license plate lamp . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
main and dipped beam . . . . . . . 81  
rear lamp unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84  
side marker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79  
side repeater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
cabin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
direction indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
entry and exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
front fog lamps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75  
glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
hazard warning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76  
headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71  
luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . 74  
reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
rear fog lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75  
sidelamps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71  
Locking the vehicle  
centre console. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141  
cigar lighter and ashtray . . . . . . . . 140  
glove box. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
accessory socket . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
sunvisors  
vanity mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141  
Interior lighting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
Interlock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
J
Jaguar parts and accessories . . . . . . . 31  
Jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243  
K
Key transmitter radio frequency . . . . 286  
Keyless entry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41  
Keyless starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Keys  
key transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34  
Keys and remote controls . . . . . . . . . . 34  
information messages. . . . . . . . . . . 38  
Smart Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35  
Kickdown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158  
drive-away locking. . . . . . . . . . . . . 43  
external locks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
internal locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43  
Locking wheel nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274  
Luggage compartment. . . . . . . . 43, 156  
emergency release. . . . . . . . . . . . . 44  
luggage cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156  
Luggage separator  
deploy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151  
install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152  
normal stowage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150  
remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151  
M
Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232  
regular servicing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Memory function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139  
Running-in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
passenger seat position . . . . . . . . 139  
recalling memorised position . . . . 139  
setting driving position . . . . . . . . . 139  
Message centre. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118  
warning messages . . . . . . . . . . . . 118  
Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89  
heating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89  
final drive unit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
S
Satellite radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199  
home screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200  
options menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204  
preset radio stations . . . . . . . . . . 200  
recalling presets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201  
receiving satellite broadcasts . . . 199  
song seek. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201  
subscription to SIRIUS. . . . . . . . . 208  
Seat belts  
interior rear view mirror . . . . . . . . . . 90  
O
Occupant protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91  
components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98  
Oil consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
Oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237  
On-board event data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
beltminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113  
during pregnancy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94  
fastening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91  
reminder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93  
tension sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92  
Seat heaters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57  
adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57  
driving position. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
heater. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
seatback tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
Security  
P
Panic alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Parkbrake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167  
cleaning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168  
system fault. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168  
touch-screen setting . . . . . . . . . . . 167  
Power steering  
fluid check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241  
Powerwash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Production option weights . . . . . . . . 279  
Protect the environment . . . . . . . . . . 232  
Puncture  
alarms and audible signals . . . . . . 49  
immobiliser. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
panic alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
Service data recording. . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
Smart Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34  
battery renewal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40  
convenience mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . 42  
irregular operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37  
Snow chains. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265  
Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272  
Spare wheel location . . . . . . . . . . . . 274  
Speed control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169  
Steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62  
audio controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
cruise controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141  
wheel changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275  
R
Radio  
display panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
Radio reception. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182  
Rain sensitive wiper control . . . . . . . . 66  
Rear impact protection . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
Rear window operation . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
Reception quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182  
Recommended engine oil . . . . . . . . . 238  
Regular servicing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232  
Remote headlight convenience. . . . . . 49  
Reporting safety defects. . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Reservoir and dipstick locations  
normally aspirated engine. . . 235, 236  
Rollover protection system . . . . . . . . 102  
Run-flat tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273  
292  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
T
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
Technical data  
damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
locking nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274  
pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28  
recommended fitment . . . . . . . . . 266  
renewal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
run-flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273  
snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265  
uniform tire quality grades . . . . . . 277  
wear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263  
wheel changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275  
winter/snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265  
Touch-screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123  
care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123  
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123  
languages and units. . . . . . . . . . . 125  
menu structure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127  
Pop-up messages . . . . . . . . . . . . 124  
systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124  
Timeout to home screen . . . . . . . 126  
use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122  
Towing eye. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226  
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Transporting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
Trip computer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120  
engine number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281  
Technical specifications  
capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285  
dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283  
Telephone  
answer options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
automatic answering. . . . . . . . . . . 214  
bluetooth description . . . . . . . . . . 210  
call continuity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220  
call volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
caller announce. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
changing a phone number . . . . . . 217  
directory capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
directory, auto download . . . . . . . 215  
do not disturb option. . . . . . . . . . . 221  
ending a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
erase the telephone directory . . . . 216  
handsfree, ending a call . . . . . . . . 220  
handsfree, making a call . . . . . . . . 220  
last 10 options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219  
magnify keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
making a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
name search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215  
pairing and docking. . . . . . . . . . . . 211  
pairing other phones . . . . . . . . . . . 213  
receiving a call. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
retrieving voice mail . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
ringtones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215  
setting up your phone for use . . . . 211  
settings menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
steering wheel controls . . . . . . . . . 220  
system overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
using a different phone . . . . . . . . . 213  
using your phone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
voice mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Telephone system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
Temporary use spare wheel . . . . . . . 272  
Tire pressure monitoring system. . . . 267  
Type approvals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286  
U
Using booster cables . . . . . . . . . . . . 243  
V
Vanity mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Vehicle care. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227  
aerial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
alloy wheels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229  
automatic car wash. . . . . . . . . . . . 227  
bird droppings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229  
carpet and mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
cloth and fabric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
convertible top . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227  
glass surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
grease and tar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229  
high pressure wash. . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229  
paint chips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
underhood. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
washing your vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . 227  
Vehicle recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
VIN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281  
W
Warning lights and indicators . . . . . . 112  
Warning triangle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
Warnings, cautions and notes. . . . . . . 30  
Warranty  
Mexico. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232  
USA and Canada. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232  
Washer fluid check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239  
Wheel changing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275  
Wheel/tire data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266  
Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
glossary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278  
temporary use spare wheel. . . . . . 272  
tire pressures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256  
wheel changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272  
Whiplash protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
Window tinting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
Windows  
anti-trap detection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86  
rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
thermal overload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
Windshield wipers/washers . . . . . . . . 65  
maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66  
Winter/snow tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265  
294  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Interfire Audio Car Amplifier G1 1200 User Manual
Jabra Bluetooth Headset BTE4 User Manual
Jackson Indoor Furnishings Scaltrol User Manual
Jenn Air Cooktop CVGX242 User Manual
Jensen MP3 Docking Station JiMS 210 User Manual
JVC Speaker CS AW6040 User Manual
Kenmore Washer Dryer 26 88752 User Manual
KitchenAid Appliance Trim Kit KERC607HBLO User Manual
KitchenAid Range KDRP707R User Manual
Konica Minolta Printer Printer Copier User Manual